1 /* ELF executable support for BFD.
3 Copyright (C) 1993-2018 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
5 This file is part of BFD, the Binary File Descriptor library.
7 This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
8 it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
9 the Free Software Foundation; either version 3 of the License, or
10 (at your option) any later version.
12 This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
13 but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
14 MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
15 GNU General Public License for more details.
17 You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
18 along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software
19 Foundation, Inc., 51 Franklin Street - Fifth Floor, Boston,
20 MA 02110-1301, USA. */
27 BFD support for ELF formats is being worked on.
28 Currently, the best supported back ends are for sparc and i386
29 (running svr4 or Solaris 2).
31 Documentation of the internals of the support code still needs
32 to be written. The code is changing quickly enough that we
33 haven't bothered yet. */
35 /* For sparc64-cross-sparc32. */
43 #include "libiberty.h"
44 #include "safe-ctype.h"
45 #include "elf-linux-core.h"
51 static int elf_sort_sections (const void *, const void *);
52 static bfd_boolean assign_file_positions_except_relocs (bfd *, struct bfd_link_info *);
53 static bfd_boolean prep_headers (bfd *);
54 static bfd_boolean swap_out_syms (bfd *, struct elf_strtab_hash **, int) ;
55 static bfd_boolean elf_read_notes (bfd *, file_ptr, bfd_size_type,
57 static bfd_boolean elf_parse_notes (bfd *abfd, char *buf, size_t size,
58 file_ptr offset, size_t align);
60 /* Swap version information in and out. The version information is
61 currently size independent. If that ever changes, this code will
62 need to move into elfcode.h. */
64 /* Swap in a Verdef structure. */
67 _bfd_elf_swap_verdef_in (bfd *abfd,
68 const Elf_External_Verdef *src,
69 Elf_Internal_Verdef *dst)
71 dst->vd_version = H_GET_16 (abfd, src->vd_version);
72 dst->vd_flags = H_GET_16 (abfd, src->vd_flags);
73 dst->vd_ndx = H_GET_16 (abfd, src->vd_ndx);
74 dst->vd_cnt = H_GET_16 (abfd, src->vd_cnt);
75 dst->vd_hash = H_GET_32 (abfd, src->vd_hash);
76 dst->vd_aux = H_GET_32 (abfd, src->vd_aux);
77 dst->vd_next = H_GET_32 (abfd, src->vd_next);
80 /* Swap out a Verdef structure. */
83 _bfd_elf_swap_verdef_out (bfd *abfd,
84 const Elf_Internal_Verdef *src,
85 Elf_External_Verdef *dst)
87 H_PUT_16 (abfd, src->vd_version, dst->vd_version);
88 H_PUT_16 (abfd, src->vd_flags, dst->vd_flags);
89 H_PUT_16 (abfd, src->vd_ndx, dst->vd_ndx);
90 H_PUT_16 (abfd, src->vd_cnt, dst->vd_cnt);
91 H_PUT_32 (abfd, src->vd_hash, dst->vd_hash);
92 H_PUT_32 (abfd, src->vd_aux, dst->vd_aux);
93 H_PUT_32 (abfd, src->vd_next, dst->vd_next);
96 /* Swap in a Verdaux structure. */
99 _bfd_elf_swap_verdaux_in (bfd *abfd,
100 const Elf_External_Verdaux *src,
101 Elf_Internal_Verdaux *dst)
103 dst->vda_name = H_GET_32 (abfd, src->vda_name);
104 dst->vda_next = H_GET_32 (abfd, src->vda_next);
107 /* Swap out a Verdaux structure. */
110 _bfd_elf_swap_verdaux_out (bfd *abfd,
111 const Elf_Internal_Verdaux *src,
112 Elf_External_Verdaux *dst)
114 H_PUT_32 (abfd, src->vda_name, dst->vda_name);
115 H_PUT_32 (abfd, src->vda_next, dst->vda_next);
118 /* Swap in a Verneed structure. */
121 _bfd_elf_swap_verneed_in (bfd *abfd,
122 const Elf_External_Verneed *src,
123 Elf_Internal_Verneed *dst)
125 dst->vn_version = H_GET_16 (abfd, src->vn_version);
126 dst->vn_cnt = H_GET_16 (abfd, src->vn_cnt);
127 dst->vn_file = H_GET_32 (abfd, src->vn_file);
128 dst->vn_aux = H_GET_32 (abfd, src->vn_aux);
129 dst->vn_next = H_GET_32 (abfd, src->vn_next);
132 /* Swap out a Verneed structure. */
135 _bfd_elf_swap_verneed_out (bfd *abfd,
136 const Elf_Internal_Verneed *src,
137 Elf_External_Verneed *dst)
139 H_PUT_16 (abfd, src->vn_version, dst->vn_version);
140 H_PUT_16 (abfd, src->vn_cnt, dst->vn_cnt);
141 H_PUT_32 (abfd, src->vn_file, dst->vn_file);
142 H_PUT_32 (abfd, src->vn_aux, dst->vn_aux);
143 H_PUT_32 (abfd, src->vn_next, dst->vn_next);
146 /* Swap in a Vernaux structure. */
149 _bfd_elf_swap_vernaux_in (bfd *abfd,
150 const Elf_External_Vernaux *src,
151 Elf_Internal_Vernaux *dst)
153 dst->vna_hash = H_GET_32 (abfd, src->vna_hash);
154 dst->vna_flags = H_GET_16 (abfd, src->vna_flags);
155 dst->vna_other = H_GET_16 (abfd, src->vna_other);
156 dst->vna_name = H_GET_32 (abfd, src->vna_name);
157 dst->vna_next = H_GET_32 (abfd, src->vna_next);
160 /* Swap out a Vernaux structure. */
163 _bfd_elf_swap_vernaux_out (bfd *abfd,
164 const Elf_Internal_Vernaux *src,
165 Elf_External_Vernaux *dst)
167 H_PUT_32 (abfd, src->vna_hash, dst->vna_hash);
168 H_PUT_16 (abfd, src->vna_flags, dst->vna_flags);
169 H_PUT_16 (abfd, src->vna_other, dst->vna_other);
170 H_PUT_32 (abfd, src->vna_name, dst->vna_name);
171 H_PUT_32 (abfd, src->vna_next, dst->vna_next);
174 /* Swap in a Versym structure. */
177 _bfd_elf_swap_versym_in (bfd *abfd,
178 const Elf_External_Versym *src,
179 Elf_Internal_Versym *dst)
181 dst->vs_vers = H_GET_16 (abfd, src->vs_vers);
184 /* Swap out a Versym structure. */
187 _bfd_elf_swap_versym_out (bfd *abfd,
188 const Elf_Internal_Versym *src,
189 Elf_External_Versym *dst)
191 H_PUT_16 (abfd, src->vs_vers, dst->vs_vers);
194 /* Standard ELF hash function. Do not change this function; you will
195 cause invalid hash tables to be generated. */
198 bfd_elf_hash (const char *namearg)
200 const unsigned char *name = (const unsigned char *) namearg;
205 while ((ch = *name++) != '\0')
208 if ((g = (h & 0xf0000000)) != 0)
211 /* The ELF ABI says `h &= ~g', but this is equivalent in
212 this case and on some machines one insn instead of two. */
216 return h & 0xffffffff;
219 /* DT_GNU_HASH hash function. Do not change this function; you will
220 cause invalid hash tables to be generated. */
223 bfd_elf_gnu_hash (const char *namearg)
225 const unsigned char *name = (const unsigned char *) namearg;
226 unsigned long h = 5381;
229 while ((ch = *name++) != '\0')
230 h = (h << 5) + h + ch;
231 return h & 0xffffffff;
234 /* Create a tdata field OBJECT_SIZE bytes in length, zeroed out and with
235 the object_id field of an elf_obj_tdata field set to OBJECT_ID. */
237 bfd_elf_allocate_object (bfd *abfd,
239 enum elf_target_id object_id)
241 BFD_ASSERT (object_size >= sizeof (struct elf_obj_tdata));
242 abfd->tdata.any = bfd_zalloc (abfd, object_size);
243 if (abfd->tdata.any == NULL)
246 elf_object_id (abfd) = object_id;
247 if (abfd->direction != read_direction)
249 struct output_elf_obj_tdata *o = bfd_zalloc (abfd, sizeof *o);
252 elf_tdata (abfd)->o = o;
253 elf_program_header_size (abfd) = (bfd_size_type) -1;
260 bfd_elf_make_object (bfd *abfd)
262 const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
263 return bfd_elf_allocate_object (abfd, sizeof (struct elf_obj_tdata),
268 bfd_elf_mkcorefile (bfd *abfd)
270 /* I think this can be done just like an object file. */
271 if (!abfd->xvec->_bfd_set_format[(int) bfd_object] (abfd))
273 elf_tdata (abfd)->core = bfd_zalloc (abfd, sizeof (*elf_tdata (abfd)->core));
274 return elf_tdata (abfd)->core != NULL;
278 bfd_elf_get_str_section (bfd *abfd, unsigned int shindex)
280 Elf_Internal_Shdr **i_shdrp;
281 bfd_byte *shstrtab = NULL;
283 bfd_size_type shstrtabsize;
285 i_shdrp = elf_elfsections (abfd);
287 || shindex >= elf_numsections (abfd)
288 || i_shdrp[shindex] == 0)
291 shstrtab = i_shdrp[shindex]->contents;
292 if (shstrtab == NULL)
294 /* No cached one, attempt to read, and cache what we read. */
295 offset = i_shdrp[shindex]->sh_offset;
296 shstrtabsize = i_shdrp[shindex]->sh_size;
298 /* Allocate and clear an extra byte at the end, to prevent crashes
299 in case the string table is not terminated. */
300 if (shstrtabsize + 1 <= 1
301 || bfd_seek (abfd, offset, SEEK_SET) != 0
302 || (shstrtab = (bfd_byte *) bfd_alloc (abfd, shstrtabsize + 1)) == NULL)
304 else if (bfd_bread (shstrtab, shstrtabsize, abfd) != shstrtabsize)
306 if (bfd_get_error () != bfd_error_system_call)
307 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_file_truncated);
308 bfd_release (abfd, shstrtab);
310 /* Once we've failed to read it, make sure we don't keep
311 trying. Otherwise, we'll keep allocating space for
312 the string table over and over. */
313 i_shdrp[shindex]->sh_size = 0;
316 shstrtab[shstrtabsize] = '\0';
317 i_shdrp[shindex]->contents = shstrtab;
319 return (char *) shstrtab;
323 bfd_elf_string_from_elf_section (bfd *abfd,
324 unsigned int shindex,
325 unsigned int strindex)
327 Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr;
332 if (elf_elfsections (abfd) == NULL || shindex >= elf_numsections (abfd))
335 hdr = elf_elfsections (abfd)[shindex];
337 if (hdr->contents == NULL)
339 if (hdr->sh_type != SHT_STRTAB && hdr->sh_type < SHT_LOOS)
341 /* PR 17512: file: f057ec89. */
342 /* xgettext:c-format */
343 _bfd_error_handler (_("%B: attempt to load strings from"
344 " a non-string section (number %d)"),
349 if (bfd_elf_get_str_section (abfd, shindex) == NULL)
353 if (strindex >= hdr->sh_size)
355 unsigned int shstrndx = elf_elfheader(abfd)->e_shstrndx;
357 /* xgettext:c-format */
358 (_("%B: invalid string offset %u >= %Lu for section `%s'"),
359 abfd, strindex, hdr->sh_size,
360 (shindex == shstrndx && strindex == hdr->sh_name
362 : bfd_elf_string_from_elf_section (abfd, shstrndx, hdr->sh_name)));
366 return ((char *) hdr->contents) + strindex;
369 /* Read and convert symbols to internal format.
370 SYMCOUNT specifies the number of symbols to read, starting from
371 symbol SYMOFFSET. If any of INTSYM_BUF, EXTSYM_BUF or EXTSHNDX_BUF
372 are non-NULL, they are used to store the internal symbols, external
373 symbols, and symbol section index extensions, respectively.
374 Returns a pointer to the internal symbol buffer (malloced if necessary)
375 or NULL if there were no symbols or some kind of problem. */
378 bfd_elf_get_elf_syms (bfd *ibfd,
379 Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr,
382 Elf_Internal_Sym *intsym_buf,
384 Elf_External_Sym_Shndx *extshndx_buf)
386 Elf_Internal_Shdr *shndx_hdr;
388 const bfd_byte *esym;
389 Elf_External_Sym_Shndx *alloc_extshndx;
390 Elf_External_Sym_Shndx *shndx;
391 Elf_Internal_Sym *alloc_intsym;
392 Elf_Internal_Sym *isym;
393 Elf_Internal_Sym *isymend;
394 const struct elf_backend_data *bed;
399 if (bfd_get_flavour (ibfd) != bfd_target_elf_flavour)
405 /* Normal syms might have section extension entries. */
407 if (elf_symtab_shndx_list (ibfd) != NULL)
409 elf_section_list * entry;
410 Elf_Internal_Shdr **sections = elf_elfsections (ibfd);
412 /* Find an index section that is linked to this symtab section. */
413 for (entry = elf_symtab_shndx_list (ibfd); entry != NULL; entry = entry->next)
416 if (entry->hdr.sh_link >= elf_numsections (ibfd))
419 if (sections[entry->hdr.sh_link] == symtab_hdr)
421 shndx_hdr = & entry->hdr;
426 if (shndx_hdr == NULL)
428 if (symtab_hdr == & elf_symtab_hdr (ibfd))
429 /* Not really accurate, but this was how the old code used to work. */
430 shndx_hdr = & elf_symtab_shndx_list (ibfd)->hdr;
431 /* Otherwise we do nothing. The assumption is that
432 the index table will not be needed. */
436 /* Read the symbols. */
438 alloc_extshndx = NULL;
440 bed = get_elf_backend_data (ibfd);
441 extsym_size = bed->s->sizeof_sym;
442 amt = (bfd_size_type) symcount * extsym_size;
443 pos = symtab_hdr->sh_offset + symoffset * extsym_size;
444 if (extsym_buf == NULL)
446 alloc_ext = bfd_malloc2 (symcount, extsym_size);
447 extsym_buf = alloc_ext;
449 if (extsym_buf == NULL
450 || bfd_seek (ibfd, pos, SEEK_SET) != 0
451 || bfd_bread (extsym_buf, amt, ibfd) != amt)
457 if (shndx_hdr == NULL || shndx_hdr->sh_size == 0)
461 amt = (bfd_size_type) symcount * sizeof (Elf_External_Sym_Shndx);
462 pos = shndx_hdr->sh_offset + symoffset * sizeof (Elf_External_Sym_Shndx);
463 if (extshndx_buf == NULL)
465 alloc_extshndx = (Elf_External_Sym_Shndx *)
466 bfd_malloc2 (symcount, sizeof (Elf_External_Sym_Shndx));
467 extshndx_buf = alloc_extshndx;
469 if (extshndx_buf == NULL
470 || bfd_seek (ibfd, pos, SEEK_SET) != 0
471 || bfd_bread (extshndx_buf, amt, ibfd) != amt)
478 if (intsym_buf == NULL)
480 alloc_intsym = (Elf_Internal_Sym *)
481 bfd_malloc2 (symcount, sizeof (Elf_Internal_Sym));
482 intsym_buf = alloc_intsym;
483 if (intsym_buf == NULL)
487 /* Convert the symbols to internal form. */
488 isymend = intsym_buf + symcount;
489 for (esym = (const bfd_byte *) extsym_buf, isym = intsym_buf,
490 shndx = extshndx_buf;
492 esym += extsym_size, isym++, shndx = shndx != NULL ? shndx + 1 : NULL)
493 if (!(*bed->s->swap_symbol_in) (ibfd, esym, shndx, isym))
495 symoffset += (esym - (bfd_byte *) extsym_buf) / extsym_size;
496 /* xgettext:c-format */
497 _bfd_error_handler (_("%B symbol number %lu references"
498 " nonexistent SHT_SYMTAB_SHNDX section"),
499 ibfd, (unsigned long) symoffset);
500 if (alloc_intsym != NULL)
507 if (alloc_ext != NULL)
509 if (alloc_extshndx != NULL)
510 free (alloc_extshndx);
515 /* Look up a symbol name. */
517 bfd_elf_sym_name (bfd *abfd,
518 Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr,
519 Elf_Internal_Sym *isym,
523 unsigned int iname = isym->st_name;
524 unsigned int shindex = symtab_hdr->sh_link;
526 if (iname == 0 && ELF_ST_TYPE (isym->st_info) == STT_SECTION
527 /* Check for a bogus st_shndx to avoid crashing. */
528 && isym->st_shndx < elf_numsections (abfd))
530 iname = elf_elfsections (abfd)[isym->st_shndx]->sh_name;
531 shindex = elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_shstrndx;
534 name = bfd_elf_string_from_elf_section (abfd, shindex, iname);
537 else if (sym_sec && *name == '\0')
538 name = bfd_section_name (abfd, sym_sec);
543 /* Elf_Internal_Shdr->contents is an array of these for SHT_GROUP
544 sections. The first element is the flags, the rest are section
547 typedef union elf_internal_group {
548 Elf_Internal_Shdr *shdr;
550 } Elf_Internal_Group;
552 /* Return the name of the group signature symbol. Why isn't the
553 signature just a string? */
556 group_signature (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Shdr *ghdr)
558 Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr;
559 unsigned char esym[sizeof (Elf64_External_Sym)];
560 Elf_External_Sym_Shndx eshndx;
561 Elf_Internal_Sym isym;
563 /* First we need to ensure the symbol table is available. Make sure
564 that it is a symbol table section. */
565 if (ghdr->sh_link >= elf_numsections (abfd))
567 hdr = elf_elfsections (abfd) [ghdr->sh_link];
568 if (hdr->sh_type != SHT_SYMTAB
569 || ! bfd_section_from_shdr (abfd, ghdr->sh_link))
572 /* Go read the symbol. */
573 hdr = &elf_tdata (abfd)->symtab_hdr;
574 if (bfd_elf_get_elf_syms (abfd, hdr, 1, ghdr->sh_info,
575 &isym, esym, &eshndx) == NULL)
578 return bfd_elf_sym_name (abfd, hdr, &isym, NULL);
581 /* Set next_in_group list pointer, and group name for NEWSECT. */
584 setup_group (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr, asection *newsect)
586 unsigned int num_group = elf_tdata (abfd)->num_group;
588 /* If num_group is zero, read in all SHT_GROUP sections. The count
589 is set to -1 if there are no SHT_GROUP sections. */
592 unsigned int i, shnum;
594 /* First count the number of groups. If we have a SHT_GROUP
595 section with just a flag word (ie. sh_size is 4), ignore it. */
596 shnum = elf_numsections (abfd);
599 #define IS_VALID_GROUP_SECTION_HEADER(shdr, minsize) \
600 ( (shdr)->sh_type == SHT_GROUP \
601 && (shdr)->sh_size >= minsize \
602 && (shdr)->sh_entsize == GRP_ENTRY_SIZE \
603 && ((shdr)->sh_size % GRP_ENTRY_SIZE) == 0)
605 for (i = 0; i < shnum; i++)
607 Elf_Internal_Shdr *shdr = elf_elfsections (abfd)[i];
609 if (IS_VALID_GROUP_SECTION_HEADER (shdr, 2 * GRP_ENTRY_SIZE))
615 num_group = (unsigned) -1;
616 elf_tdata (abfd)->num_group = num_group;
617 elf_tdata (abfd)->group_sect_ptr = NULL;
621 /* We keep a list of elf section headers for group sections,
622 so we can find them quickly. */
625 elf_tdata (abfd)->num_group = num_group;
626 elf_tdata (abfd)->group_sect_ptr = (Elf_Internal_Shdr **)
627 bfd_alloc2 (abfd, num_group, sizeof (Elf_Internal_Shdr *));
628 if (elf_tdata (abfd)->group_sect_ptr == NULL)
630 memset (elf_tdata (abfd)->group_sect_ptr, 0, num_group * sizeof (Elf_Internal_Shdr *));
633 for (i = 0; i < shnum; i++)
635 Elf_Internal_Shdr *shdr = elf_elfsections (abfd)[i];
637 if (IS_VALID_GROUP_SECTION_HEADER (shdr, 2 * GRP_ENTRY_SIZE))
640 Elf_Internal_Group *dest;
642 /* Make sure the group section has a BFD section
644 if (!bfd_section_from_shdr (abfd, i))
647 /* Add to list of sections. */
648 elf_tdata (abfd)->group_sect_ptr[num_group] = shdr;
651 /* Read the raw contents. */
652 BFD_ASSERT (sizeof (*dest) >= 4);
653 amt = shdr->sh_size * sizeof (*dest) / 4;
654 shdr->contents = (unsigned char *)
655 bfd_alloc2 (abfd, shdr->sh_size, sizeof (*dest) / 4);
656 /* PR binutils/4110: Handle corrupt group headers. */
657 if (shdr->contents == NULL)
660 /* xgettext:c-format */
661 (_("%B: corrupt size field in group section"
662 " header: %#Lx"), abfd, shdr->sh_size);
663 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
668 memset (shdr->contents, 0, amt);
670 if (bfd_seek (abfd, shdr->sh_offset, SEEK_SET) != 0
671 || (bfd_bread (shdr->contents, shdr->sh_size, abfd)
675 /* xgettext:c-format */
676 (_("%B: invalid size field in group section"
677 " header: %#Lx"), abfd, shdr->sh_size);
678 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
680 /* PR 17510: If the group contents are even
681 partially corrupt, do not allow any of the
682 contents to be used. */
683 memset (shdr->contents, 0, amt);
687 /* Translate raw contents, a flag word followed by an
688 array of elf section indices all in target byte order,
689 to the flag word followed by an array of elf section
691 src = shdr->contents + shdr->sh_size;
692 dest = (Elf_Internal_Group *) (shdr->contents + amt);
700 idx = H_GET_32 (abfd, src);
701 if (src == shdr->contents)
704 if (shdr->bfd_section != NULL && (idx & GRP_COMDAT))
705 shdr->bfd_section->flags
706 |= SEC_LINK_ONCE | SEC_LINK_DUPLICATES_DISCARD;
712 (_("%B: invalid SHT_GROUP entry"), abfd);
715 dest->shdr = elf_elfsections (abfd)[idx];
720 /* PR 17510: Corrupt binaries might contain invalid groups. */
721 if (num_group != (unsigned) elf_tdata (abfd)->num_group)
723 elf_tdata (abfd)->num_group = num_group;
725 /* If all groups are invalid then fail. */
728 elf_tdata (abfd)->group_sect_ptr = NULL;
729 elf_tdata (abfd)->num_group = num_group = -1;
731 (_("%B: no valid group sections found"), abfd);
732 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
738 if (num_group != (unsigned) -1)
740 unsigned int search_offset = elf_tdata (abfd)->group_search_offset;
743 for (j = 0; j < num_group; j++)
745 /* Begin search from previous found group. */
746 unsigned i = (j + search_offset) % num_group;
748 Elf_Internal_Shdr *shdr = elf_tdata (abfd)->group_sect_ptr[i];
749 Elf_Internal_Group *idx;
755 idx = (Elf_Internal_Group *) shdr->contents;
756 if (idx == NULL || shdr->sh_size < 4)
758 /* See PR 21957 for a reproducer. */
759 /* xgettext:c-format */
760 _bfd_error_handler (_("%B: group section '%A' has no contents"),
761 abfd, shdr->bfd_section);
762 elf_tdata (abfd)->group_sect_ptr[i] = NULL;
763 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
766 n_elt = shdr->sh_size / 4;
768 /* Look through this group's sections to see if current
769 section is a member. */
771 if ((++idx)->shdr == hdr)
775 /* We are a member of this group. Go looking through
776 other members to see if any others are linked via
778 idx = (Elf_Internal_Group *) shdr->contents;
779 n_elt = shdr->sh_size / 4;
781 if ((s = (++idx)->shdr->bfd_section) != NULL
782 && elf_next_in_group (s) != NULL)
786 /* Snarf the group name from other member, and
787 insert current section in circular list. */
788 elf_group_name (newsect) = elf_group_name (s);
789 elf_next_in_group (newsect) = elf_next_in_group (s);
790 elf_next_in_group (s) = newsect;
796 gname = group_signature (abfd, shdr);
799 elf_group_name (newsect) = gname;
801 /* Start a circular list with one element. */
802 elf_next_in_group (newsect) = newsect;
805 /* If the group section has been created, point to the
807 if (shdr->bfd_section != NULL)
808 elf_next_in_group (shdr->bfd_section) = newsect;
810 elf_tdata (abfd)->group_search_offset = i;
817 if (elf_group_name (newsect) == NULL)
819 /* xgettext:c-format */
820 _bfd_error_handler (_("%B: no group info for section '%A'"),
828 _bfd_elf_setup_sections (bfd *abfd)
831 unsigned int num_group = elf_tdata (abfd)->num_group;
832 bfd_boolean result = TRUE;
835 /* Process SHF_LINK_ORDER. */
836 for (s = abfd->sections; s != NULL; s = s->next)
838 Elf_Internal_Shdr *this_hdr = &elf_section_data (s)->this_hdr;
839 if ((this_hdr->sh_flags & SHF_LINK_ORDER) != 0)
841 unsigned int elfsec = this_hdr->sh_link;
842 /* FIXME: The old Intel compiler and old strip/objcopy may
843 not set the sh_link or sh_info fields. Hence we could
844 get the situation where elfsec is 0. */
847 const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
848 if (bed->link_order_error_handler)
849 bed->link_order_error_handler
850 /* xgettext:c-format */
851 (_("%B: warning: sh_link not set for section `%A'"),
856 asection *linksec = NULL;
858 if (elfsec < elf_numsections (abfd))
860 this_hdr = elf_elfsections (abfd)[elfsec];
861 linksec = this_hdr->bfd_section;
865 Some strip/objcopy may leave an incorrect value in
866 sh_link. We don't want to proceed. */
870 /* xgettext:c-format */
871 (_("%B: sh_link [%d] in section `%A' is incorrect"),
872 s->owner, elfsec, s);
876 elf_linked_to_section (s) = linksec;
879 else if (this_hdr->sh_type == SHT_GROUP
880 && elf_next_in_group (s) == NULL)
883 /* xgettext:c-format */
884 (_("%B: SHT_GROUP section [index %d] has no SHF_GROUP sections"),
885 abfd, elf_section_data (s)->this_idx);
890 /* Process section groups. */
891 if (num_group == (unsigned) -1)
894 for (i = 0; i < num_group; i++)
896 Elf_Internal_Shdr *shdr = elf_tdata (abfd)->group_sect_ptr[i];
897 Elf_Internal_Group *idx;
900 /* PR binutils/18758: Beware of corrupt binaries with invalid group data. */
901 if (shdr == NULL || shdr->bfd_section == NULL || shdr->contents == NULL)
904 /* xgettext:c-format */
905 (_("%B: section group entry number %u is corrupt"),
911 idx = (Elf_Internal_Group *) shdr->contents;
912 n_elt = shdr->sh_size / 4;
918 if (idx->shdr == NULL)
920 else if (idx->shdr->bfd_section)
921 elf_sec_group (idx->shdr->bfd_section) = shdr->bfd_section;
922 else if (idx->shdr->sh_type != SHT_RELA
923 && idx->shdr->sh_type != SHT_REL)
925 /* There are some unknown sections in the group. */
927 /* xgettext:c-format */
928 (_("%B: unknown type [%#x] section `%s' in group [%A]"),
931 bfd_elf_string_from_elf_section (abfd,
932 (elf_elfheader (abfd)
945 bfd_elf_is_group_section (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, const asection *sec)
947 return elf_next_in_group (sec) != NULL;
951 convert_debug_to_zdebug (bfd *abfd, const char *name)
953 unsigned int len = strlen (name);
954 char *new_name = bfd_alloc (abfd, len + 2);
955 if (new_name == NULL)
959 memcpy (new_name + 2, name + 1, len);
964 convert_zdebug_to_debug (bfd *abfd, const char *name)
966 unsigned int len = strlen (name);
967 char *new_name = bfd_alloc (abfd, len);
968 if (new_name == NULL)
971 memcpy (new_name + 1, name + 2, len - 1);
975 /* Make a BFD section from an ELF section. We store a pointer to the
976 BFD section in the bfd_section field of the header. */
979 _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (bfd *abfd,
980 Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr,
986 const struct elf_backend_data *bed;
988 if (hdr->bfd_section != NULL)
991 newsect = bfd_make_section_anyway (abfd, name);
995 hdr->bfd_section = newsect;
996 elf_section_data (newsect)->this_hdr = *hdr;
997 elf_section_data (newsect)->this_idx = shindex;
999 /* Always use the real type/flags. */
1000 elf_section_type (newsect) = hdr->sh_type;
1001 elf_section_flags (newsect) = hdr->sh_flags;
1003 newsect->filepos = hdr->sh_offset;
1005 if (! bfd_set_section_vma (abfd, newsect, hdr->sh_addr)
1006 || ! bfd_set_section_size (abfd, newsect, hdr->sh_size)
1007 || ! bfd_set_section_alignment (abfd, newsect,
1008 bfd_log2 (hdr->sh_addralign)))
1011 flags = SEC_NO_FLAGS;
1012 if (hdr->sh_type != SHT_NOBITS)
1013 flags |= SEC_HAS_CONTENTS;
1014 if (hdr->sh_type == SHT_GROUP)
1016 if ((hdr->sh_flags & SHF_ALLOC) != 0)
1019 if (hdr->sh_type != SHT_NOBITS)
1022 if ((hdr->sh_flags & SHF_WRITE) == 0)
1023 flags |= SEC_READONLY;
1024 if ((hdr->sh_flags & SHF_EXECINSTR) != 0)
1026 else if ((flags & SEC_LOAD) != 0)
1028 if ((hdr->sh_flags & SHF_MERGE) != 0)
1031 newsect->entsize = hdr->sh_entsize;
1033 if ((hdr->sh_flags & SHF_STRINGS) != 0)
1034 flags |= SEC_STRINGS;
1035 if (hdr->sh_flags & SHF_GROUP)
1036 if (!setup_group (abfd, hdr, newsect))
1038 if ((hdr->sh_flags & SHF_TLS) != 0)
1039 flags |= SEC_THREAD_LOCAL;
1040 if ((hdr->sh_flags & SHF_EXCLUDE) != 0)
1041 flags |= SEC_EXCLUDE;
1043 if ((flags & SEC_ALLOC) == 0)
1045 /* The debugging sections appear to be recognized only by name,
1046 not any sort of flag. Their SEC_ALLOC bits are cleared. */
1047 if (name [0] == '.')
1052 p = ".debug", n = 6;
1053 else if (name[1] == 'g' && name[2] == 'n')
1054 p = ".gnu.linkonce.wi.", n = 17;
1055 else if (name[1] == 'g' && name[2] == 'd')
1056 p = ".gdb_index", n = 11; /* yes we really do mean 11. */
1057 else if (name[1] == 'l')
1059 else if (name[1] == 's')
1061 else if (name[1] == 'z')
1062 p = ".zdebug", n = 7;
1065 if (p != NULL && strncmp (name, p, n) == 0)
1066 flags |= SEC_DEBUGGING;
1070 /* As a GNU extension, if the name begins with .gnu.linkonce, we
1071 only link a single copy of the section. This is used to support
1072 g++. g++ will emit each template expansion in its own section.
1073 The symbols will be defined as weak, so that multiple definitions
1074 are permitted. The GNU linker extension is to actually discard
1075 all but one of the sections. */
1076 if (CONST_STRNEQ (name, ".gnu.linkonce")
1077 && elf_next_in_group (newsect) == NULL)
1078 flags |= SEC_LINK_ONCE | SEC_LINK_DUPLICATES_DISCARD;
1080 bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
1081 if (bed->elf_backend_section_flags)
1082 if (! bed->elf_backend_section_flags (&flags, hdr))
1085 if (! bfd_set_section_flags (abfd, newsect, flags))
1088 /* We do not parse the PT_NOTE segments as we are interested even in the
1089 separate debug info files which may have the segments offsets corrupted.
1090 PT_NOTEs from the core files are currently not parsed using BFD. */
1091 if (hdr->sh_type == SHT_NOTE)
1095 if (!bfd_malloc_and_get_section (abfd, newsect, &contents))
1098 elf_parse_notes (abfd, (char *) contents, hdr->sh_size,
1099 hdr->sh_offset, hdr->sh_addralign);
1103 if ((flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0)
1105 Elf_Internal_Phdr *phdr;
1106 unsigned int i, nload;
1108 /* Some ELF linkers produce binaries with all the program header
1109 p_paddr fields zero. If we have such a binary with more than
1110 one PT_LOAD header, then leave the section lma equal to vma
1111 so that we don't create sections with overlapping lma. */
1112 phdr = elf_tdata (abfd)->phdr;
1113 for (nload = 0, i = 0; i < elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_phnum; i++, phdr++)
1114 if (phdr->p_paddr != 0)
1116 else if (phdr->p_type == PT_LOAD && phdr->p_memsz != 0)
1118 if (i >= elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_phnum && nload > 1)
1121 phdr = elf_tdata (abfd)->phdr;
1122 for (i = 0; i < elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_phnum; i++, phdr++)
1124 if (((phdr->p_type == PT_LOAD
1125 && (hdr->sh_flags & SHF_TLS) == 0)
1126 || phdr->p_type == PT_TLS)
1127 && ELF_SECTION_IN_SEGMENT (hdr, phdr))
1129 if ((flags & SEC_LOAD) == 0)
1130 newsect->lma = (phdr->p_paddr
1131 + hdr->sh_addr - phdr->p_vaddr);
1133 /* We used to use the same adjustment for SEC_LOAD
1134 sections, but that doesn't work if the segment
1135 is packed with code from multiple VMAs.
1136 Instead we calculate the section LMA based on
1137 the segment LMA. It is assumed that the
1138 segment will contain sections with contiguous
1139 LMAs, even if the VMAs are not. */
1140 newsect->lma = (phdr->p_paddr
1141 + hdr->sh_offset - phdr->p_offset);
1143 /* With contiguous segments, we can't tell from file
1144 offsets whether a section with zero size should
1145 be placed at the end of one segment or the
1146 beginning of the next. Decide based on vaddr. */
1147 if (hdr->sh_addr >= phdr->p_vaddr
1148 && (hdr->sh_addr + hdr->sh_size
1149 <= phdr->p_vaddr + phdr->p_memsz))
1155 /* Compress/decompress DWARF debug sections with names: .debug_* and
1156 .zdebug_*, after the section flags is set. */
1157 if ((flags & SEC_DEBUGGING)
1158 && ((name[1] == 'd' && name[6] == '_')
1159 || (name[1] == 'z' && name[7] == '_')))
1161 enum { nothing, compress, decompress } action = nothing;
1162 int compression_header_size;
1163 bfd_size_type uncompressed_size;
1164 bfd_boolean compressed
1165 = bfd_is_section_compressed_with_header (abfd, newsect,
1166 &compression_header_size,
1167 &uncompressed_size);
1171 /* Compressed section. Check if we should decompress. */
1172 if ((abfd->flags & BFD_DECOMPRESS))
1173 action = decompress;
1176 /* Compress the uncompressed section or convert from/to .zdebug*
1177 section. Check if we should compress. */
1178 if (action == nothing)
1180 if (newsect->size != 0
1181 && (abfd->flags & BFD_COMPRESS)
1182 && compression_header_size >= 0
1183 && uncompressed_size > 0
1185 || ((compression_header_size > 0)
1186 != ((abfd->flags & BFD_COMPRESS_GABI) != 0))))
1192 if (action == compress)
1194 if (!bfd_init_section_compress_status (abfd, newsect))
1197 /* xgettext:c-format */
1198 (_("%B: unable to initialize compress status for section %s"),
1205 if (!bfd_init_section_decompress_status (abfd, newsect))
1208 /* xgettext:c-format */
1209 (_("%B: unable to initialize decompress status for section %s"),
1215 if (abfd->is_linker_input)
1218 && (action == decompress
1219 || (action == compress
1220 && (abfd->flags & BFD_COMPRESS_GABI) != 0)))
1222 /* Convert section name from .zdebug_* to .debug_* so
1223 that linker will consider this section as a debug
1225 char *new_name = convert_zdebug_to_debug (abfd, name);
1226 if (new_name == NULL)
1228 bfd_rename_section (abfd, newsect, new_name);
1232 /* For objdump, don't rename the section. For objcopy, delay
1233 section rename to elf_fake_sections. */
1234 newsect->flags |= SEC_ELF_RENAME;
1240 const char *const bfd_elf_section_type_names[] =
1242 "SHT_NULL", "SHT_PROGBITS", "SHT_SYMTAB", "SHT_STRTAB",
1243 "SHT_RELA", "SHT_HASH", "SHT_DYNAMIC", "SHT_NOTE",
1244 "SHT_NOBITS", "SHT_REL", "SHT_SHLIB", "SHT_DYNSYM",
1247 /* ELF relocs are against symbols. If we are producing relocatable
1248 output, and the reloc is against an external symbol, and nothing
1249 has given us any additional addend, the resulting reloc will also
1250 be against the same symbol. In such a case, we don't want to
1251 change anything about the way the reloc is handled, since it will
1252 all be done at final link time. Rather than put special case code
1253 into bfd_perform_relocation, all the reloc types use this howto
1254 function. It just short circuits the reloc if producing
1255 relocatable output against an external symbol. */
1257 bfd_reloc_status_type
1258 bfd_elf_generic_reloc (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
1259 arelent *reloc_entry,
1261 void *data ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
1262 asection *input_section,
1264 char **error_message ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
1266 if (output_bfd != NULL
1267 && (symbol->flags & BSF_SECTION_SYM) == 0
1268 && (! reloc_entry->howto->partial_inplace
1269 || reloc_entry->addend == 0))
1271 reloc_entry->address += input_section->output_offset;
1272 return bfd_reloc_ok;
1275 return bfd_reloc_continue;
1278 /* Returns TRUE if section A matches section B.
1279 Names, addresses and links may be different, but everything else
1280 should be the same. */
1283 section_match (const Elf_Internal_Shdr * a,
1284 const Elf_Internal_Shdr * b)
1287 a->sh_type == b->sh_type
1288 && (a->sh_flags & ~ SHF_INFO_LINK)
1289 == (b->sh_flags & ~ SHF_INFO_LINK)
1290 && a->sh_addralign == b->sh_addralign
1291 && a->sh_size == b->sh_size
1292 && a->sh_entsize == b->sh_entsize
1293 /* FIXME: Check sh_addr ? */
1297 /* Find a section in OBFD that has the same characteristics
1298 as IHEADER. Return the index of this section or SHN_UNDEF if
1299 none can be found. Check's section HINT first, as this is likely
1300 to be the correct section. */
1303 find_link (const bfd *obfd, const Elf_Internal_Shdr *iheader,
1304 const unsigned int hint)
1306 Elf_Internal_Shdr ** oheaders = elf_elfsections (obfd);
1309 BFD_ASSERT (iheader != NULL);
1311 /* See PR 20922 for a reproducer of the NULL test. */
1312 if (hint < elf_numsections (obfd)
1313 && oheaders[hint] != NULL
1314 && section_match (oheaders[hint], iheader))
1317 for (i = 1; i < elf_numsections (obfd); i++)
1319 Elf_Internal_Shdr * oheader = oheaders[i];
1321 if (oheader == NULL)
1323 if (section_match (oheader, iheader))
1324 /* FIXME: Do we care if there is a potential for
1325 multiple matches ? */
1332 /* PR 19938: Attempt to set the ELF section header fields of an OS or
1333 Processor specific section, based upon a matching input section.
1334 Returns TRUE upon success, FALSE otherwise. */
1337 copy_special_section_fields (const bfd *ibfd,
1339 const Elf_Internal_Shdr *iheader,
1340 Elf_Internal_Shdr *oheader,
1341 const unsigned int secnum)
1343 const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (obfd);
1344 const Elf_Internal_Shdr **iheaders = (const Elf_Internal_Shdr **) elf_elfsections (ibfd);
1345 bfd_boolean changed = FALSE;
1346 unsigned int sh_link;
1348 if (oheader->sh_type == SHT_NOBITS)
1350 /* This is a feature for objcopy --only-keep-debug:
1351 When a section's type is changed to NOBITS, we preserve
1352 the sh_link and sh_info fields so that they can be
1353 matched up with the original.
1355 Note: Strictly speaking these assignments are wrong.
1356 The sh_link and sh_info fields should point to the
1357 relevent sections in the output BFD, which may not be in
1358 the same location as they were in the input BFD. But
1359 the whole point of this action is to preserve the
1360 original values of the sh_link and sh_info fields, so
1361 that they can be matched up with the section headers in
1362 the original file. So strictly speaking we may be
1363 creating an invalid ELF file, but it is only for a file
1364 that just contains debug info and only for sections
1365 without any contents. */
1366 if (oheader->sh_link == 0)
1367 oheader->sh_link = iheader->sh_link;
1368 if (oheader->sh_info == 0)
1369 oheader->sh_info = iheader->sh_info;
1373 /* Allow the target a chance to decide how these fields should be set. */
1374 if (bed->elf_backend_copy_special_section_fields != NULL
1375 && bed->elf_backend_copy_special_section_fields
1376 (ibfd, obfd, iheader, oheader))
1379 /* We have an iheader which might match oheader, and which has non-zero
1380 sh_info and/or sh_link fields. Attempt to follow those links and find
1381 the section in the output bfd which corresponds to the linked section
1382 in the input bfd. */
1383 if (iheader->sh_link != SHN_UNDEF)
1385 /* See PR 20931 for a reproducer. */
1386 if (iheader->sh_link >= elf_numsections (ibfd))
1389 /* xgettext:c-format */
1390 (_("%B: Invalid sh_link field (%d) in section number %d"),
1391 ibfd, iheader->sh_link, secnum);
1395 sh_link = find_link (obfd, iheaders[iheader->sh_link], iheader->sh_link);
1396 if (sh_link != SHN_UNDEF)
1398 oheader->sh_link = sh_link;
1402 /* FIXME: Should we install iheader->sh_link
1403 if we could not find a match ? */
1405 /* xgettext:c-format */
1406 (_("%B: Failed to find link section for section %d"), obfd, secnum);
1409 if (iheader->sh_info)
1411 /* The sh_info field can hold arbitrary information, but if the
1412 SHF_LINK_INFO flag is set then it should be interpreted as a
1414 if (iheader->sh_flags & SHF_INFO_LINK)
1416 sh_link = find_link (obfd, iheaders[iheader->sh_info],
1418 if (sh_link != SHN_UNDEF)
1419 oheader->sh_flags |= SHF_INFO_LINK;
1422 /* No idea what it means - just copy it. */
1423 sh_link = iheader->sh_info;
1425 if (sh_link != SHN_UNDEF)
1427 oheader->sh_info = sh_link;
1432 /* xgettext:c-format */
1433 (_("%B: Failed to find info section for section %d"), obfd, secnum);
1439 /* Copy the program header and other data from one object module to
1443 _bfd_elf_copy_private_bfd_data (bfd *ibfd, bfd *obfd)
1445 const Elf_Internal_Shdr **iheaders = (const Elf_Internal_Shdr **) elf_elfsections (ibfd);
1446 Elf_Internal_Shdr **oheaders = elf_elfsections (obfd);
1447 const struct elf_backend_data *bed;
1450 if (bfd_get_flavour (ibfd) != bfd_target_elf_flavour
1451 || bfd_get_flavour (obfd) != bfd_target_elf_flavour)
1454 if (!elf_flags_init (obfd))
1456 elf_elfheader (obfd)->e_flags = elf_elfheader (ibfd)->e_flags;
1457 elf_flags_init (obfd) = TRUE;
1460 elf_gp (obfd) = elf_gp (ibfd);
1462 /* Also copy the EI_OSABI field. */
1463 elf_elfheader (obfd)->e_ident[EI_OSABI] =
1464 elf_elfheader (ibfd)->e_ident[EI_OSABI];
1466 /* If set, copy the EI_ABIVERSION field. */
1467 if (elf_elfheader (ibfd)->e_ident[EI_ABIVERSION])
1468 elf_elfheader (obfd)->e_ident[EI_ABIVERSION]
1469 = elf_elfheader (ibfd)->e_ident[EI_ABIVERSION];
1471 /* Copy object attributes. */
1472 _bfd_elf_copy_obj_attributes (ibfd, obfd);
1474 if (iheaders == NULL || oheaders == NULL)
1477 bed = get_elf_backend_data (obfd);
1479 /* Possibly copy other fields in the section header. */
1480 for (i = 1; i < elf_numsections (obfd); i++)
1483 Elf_Internal_Shdr * oheader = oheaders[i];
1485 /* Ignore ordinary sections. SHT_NOBITS sections are considered however
1486 because of a special case need for generating separate debug info
1487 files. See below for more details. */
1489 || (oheader->sh_type != SHT_NOBITS
1490 && oheader->sh_type < SHT_LOOS))
1493 /* Ignore empty sections, and sections whose
1494 fields have already been initialised. */
1495 if (oheader->sh_size == 0
1496 || (oheader->sh_info != 0 && oheader->sh_link != 0))
1499 /* Scan for the matching section in the input bfd.
1500 First we try for a direct mapping between the input and output sections. */
1501 for (j = 1; j < elf_numsections (ibfd); j++)
1503 const Elf_Internal_Shdr * iheader = iheaders[j];
1505 if (iheader == NULL)
1508 if (oheader->bfd_section != NULL
1509 && iheader->bfd_section != NULL
1510 && iheader->bfd_section->output_section != NULL
1511 && iheader->bfd_section->output_section == oheader->bfd_section)
1513 /* We have found a connection from the input section to the
1514 output section. Attempt to copy the header fields. If
1515 this fails then do not try any further sections - there
1516 should only be a one-to-one mapping between input and output. */
1517 if (! copy_special_section_fields (ibfd, obfd, iheader, oheader, i))
1518 j = elf_numsections (ibfd);
1523 if (j < elf_numsections (ibfd))
1526 /* That failed. So try to deduce the corresponding input section.
1527 Unfortunately we cannot compare names as the output string table
1528 is empty, so instead we check size, address and type. */
1529 for (j = 1; j < elf_numsections (ibfd); j++)
1531 const Elf_Internal_Shdr * iheader = iheaders[j];
1533 if (iheader == NULL)
1536 /* Try matching fields in the input section's header.
1537 Since --only-keep-debug turns all non-debug sections into
1538 SHT_NOBITS sections, the output SHT_NOBITS type matches any
1540 if ((oheader->sh_type == SHT_NOBITS
1541 || iheader->sh_type == oheader->sh_type)
1542 && (iheader->sh_flags & ~ SHF_INFO_LINK)
1543 == (oheader->sh_flags & ~ SHF_INFO_LINK)
1544 && iheader->sh_addralign == oheader->sh_addralign
1545 && iheader->sh_entsize == oheader->sh_entsize
1546 && iheader->sh_size == oheader->sh_size
1547 && iheader->sh_addr == oheader->sh_addr
1548 && (iheader->sh_info != oheader->sh_info
1549 || iheader->sh_link != oheader->sh_link))
1551 if (copy_special_section_fields (ibfd, obfd, iheader, oheader, i))
1556 if (j == elf_numsections (ibfd) && oheader->sh_type >= SHT_LOOS)
1558 /* Final attempt. Call the backend copy function
1559 with a NULL input section. */
1560 if (bed->elf_backend_copy_special_section_fields != NULL)
1561 bed->elf_backend_copy_special_section_fields (ibfd, obfd, NULL, oheader);
1569 get_segment_type (unsigned int p_type)
1574 case PT_NULL: pt = "NULL"; break;
1575 case PT_LOAD: pt = "LOAD"; break;
1576 case PT_DYNAMIC: pt = "DYNAMIC"; break;
1577 case PT_INTERP: pt = "INTERP"; break;
1578 case PT_NOTE: pt = "NOTE"; break;
1579 case PT_SHLIB: pt = "SHLIB"; break;
1580 case PT_PHDR: pt = "PHDR"; break;
1581 case PT_TLS: pt = "TLS"; break;
1582 case PT_GNU_EH_FRAME: pt = "EH_FRAME"; break;
1583 case PT_GNU_STACK: pt = "STACK"; break;
1584 case PT_GNU_RELRO: pt = "RELRO"; break;
1585 default: pt = NULL; break;
1590 /* Print out the program headers. */
1593 _bfd_elf_print_private_bfd_data (bfd *abfd, void *farg)
1595 FILE *f = (FILE *) farg;
1596 Elf_Internal_Phdr *p;
1598 bfd_byte *dynbuf = NULL;
1600 p = elf_tdata (abfd)->phdr;
1605 fprintf (f, _("\nProgram Header:\n"));
1606 c = elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_phnum;
1607 for (i = 0; i < c; i++, p++)
1609 const char *pt = get_segment_type (p->p_type);
1614 sprintf (buf, "0x%lx", p->p_type);
1617 fprintf (f, "%8s off 0x", pt);
1618 bfd_fprintf_vma (abfd, f, p->p_offset);
1619 fprintf (f, " vaddr 0x");
1620 bfd_fprintf_vma (abfd, f, p->p_vaddr);
1621 fprintf (f, " paddr 0x");
1622 bfd_fprintf_vma (abfd, f, p->p_paddr);
1623 fprintf (f, " align 2**%u\n", bfd_log2 (p->p_align));
1624 fprintf (f, " filesz 0x");
1625 bfd_fprintf_vma (abfd, f, p->p_filesz);
1626 fprintf (f, " memsz 0x");
1627 bfd_fprintf_vma (abfd, f, p->p_memsz);
1628 fprintf (f, " flags %c%c%c",
1629 (p->p_flags & PF_R) != 0 ? 'r' : '-',
1630 (p->p_flags & PF_W) != 0 ? 'w' : '-',
1631 (p->p_flags & PF_X) != 0 ? 'x' : '-');
1632 if ((p->p_flags &~ (unsigned) (PF_R | PF_W | PF_X)) != 0)
1633 fprintf (f, " %lx", p->p_flags &~ (unsigned) (PF_R | PF_W | PF_X));
1638 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".dynamic");
1641 unsigned int elfsec;
1642 unsigned long shlink;
1643 bfd_byte *extdyn, *extdynend;
1645 void (*swap_dyn_in) (bfd *, const void *, Elf_Internal_Dyn *);
1647 fprintf (f, _("\nDynamic Section:\n"));
1649 if (!bfd_malloc_and_get_section (abfd, s, &dynbuf))
1652 elfsec = _bfd_elf_section_from_bfd_section (abfd, s);
1653 if (elfsec == SHN_BAD)
1655 shlink = elf_elfsections (abfd)[elfsec]->sh_link;
1657 extdynsize = get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->s->sizeof_dyn;
1658 swap_dyn_in = get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->s->swap_dyn_in;
1661 /* PR 17512: file: 6f427532. */
1662 if (s->size < extdynsize)
1664 extdynend = extdyn + s->size;
1665 /* PR 17512: file: id:000006,sig:06,src:000000,op:flip4,pos:5664.
1667 for (; extdyn <= (extdynend - extdynsize); extdyn += extdynsize)
1669 Elf_Internal_Dyn dyn;
1670 const char *name = "";
1672 bfd_boolean stringp;
1673 const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
1675 (*swap_dyn_in) (abfd, extdyn, &dyn);
1677 if (dyn.d_tag == DT_NULL)
1684 if (bed->elf_backend_get_target_dtag)
1685 name = (*bed->elf_backend_get_target_dtag) (dyn.d_tag);
1687 if (!strcmp (name, ""))
1689 sprintf (ab, "%#" BFD_VMA_FMT "x", dyn.d_tag);
1694 case DT_NEEDED: name = "NEEDED"; stringp = TRUE; break;
1695 case DT_PLTRELSZ: name = "PLTRELSZ"; break;
1696 case DT_PLTGOT: name = "PLTGOT"; break;
1697 case DT_HASH: name = "HASH"; break;
1698 case DT_STRTAB: name = "STRTAB"; break;
1699 case DT_SYMTAB: name = "SYMTAB"; break;
1700 case DT_RELA: name = "RELA"; break;
1701 case DT_RELASZ: name = "RELASZ"; break;
1702 case DT_RELAENT: name = "RELAENT"; break;
1703 case DT_STRSZ: name = "STRSZ"; break;
1704 case DT_SYMENT: name = "SYMENT"; break;
1705 case DT_INIT: name = "INIT"; break;
1706 case DT_FINI: name = "FINI"; break;
1707 case DT_SONAME: name = "SONAME"; stringp = TRUE; break;
1708 case DT_RPATH: name = "RPATH"; stringp = TRUE; break;
1709 case DT_SYMBOLIC: name = "SYMBOLIC"; break;
1710 case DT_REL: name = "REL"; break;
1711 case DT_RELSZ: name = "RELSZ"; break;
1712 case DT_RELENT: name = "RELENT"; break;
1713 case DT_PLTREL: name = "PLTREL"; break;
1714 case DT_DEBUG: name = "DEBUG"; break;
1715 case DT_TEXTREL: name = "TEXTREL"; break;
1716 case DT_JMPREL: name = "JMPREL"; break;
1717 case DT_BIND_NOW: name = "BIND_NOW"; break;
1718 case DT_INIT_ARRAY: name = "INIT_ARRAY"; break;
1719 case DT_FINI_ARRAY: name = "FINI_ARRAY"; break;
1720 case DT_INIT_ARRAYSZ: name = "INIT_ARRAYSZ"; break;
1721 case DT_FINI_ARRAYSZ: name = "FINI_ARRAYSZ"; break;
1722 case DT_RUNPATH: name = "RUNPATH"; stringp = TRUE; break;
1723 case DT_FLAGS: name = "FLAGS"; break;
1724 case DT_PREINIT_ARRAY: name = "PREINIT_ARRAY"; break;
1725 case DT_PREINIT_ARRAYSZ: name = "PREINIT_ARRAYSZ"; break;
1726 case DT_CHECKSUM: name = "CHECKSUM"; break;
1727 case DT_PLTPADSZ: name = "PLTPADSZ"; break;
1728 case DT_MOVEENT: name = "MOVEENT"; break;
1729 case DT_MOVESZ: name = "MOVESZ"; break;
1730 case DT_FEATURE: name = "FEATURE"; break;
1731 case DT_POSFLAG_1: name = "POSFLAG_1"; break;
1732 case DT_SYMINSZ: name = "SYMINSZ"; break;
1733 case DT_SYMINENT: name = "SYMINENT"; break;
1734 case DT_CONFIG: name = "CONFIG"; stringp = TRUE; break;
1735 case DT_DEPAUDIT: name = "DEPAUDIT"; stringp = TRUE; break;
1736 case DT_AUDIT: name = "AUDIT"; stringp = TRUE; break;
1737 case DT_PLTPAD: name = "PLTPAD"; break;
1738 case DT_MOVETAB: name = "MOVETAB"; break;
1739 case DT_SYMINFO: name = "SYMINFO"; break;
1740 case DT_RELACOUNT: name = "RELACOUNT"; break;
1741 case DT_RELCOUNT: name = "RELCOUNT"; break;
1742 case DT_FLAGS_1: name = "FLAGS_1"; break;
1743 case DT_VERSYM: name = "VERSYM"; break;
1744 case DT_VERDEF: name = "VERDEF"; break;
1745 case DT_VERDEFNUM: name = "VERDEFNUM"; break;
1746 case DT_VERNEED: name = "VERNEED"; break;
1747 case DT_VERNEEDNUM: name = "VERNEEDNUM"; break;
1748 case DT_AUXILIARY: name = "AUXILIARY"; stringp = TRUE; break;
1749 case DT_USED: name = "USED"; break;
1750 case DT_FILTER: name = "FILTER"; stringp = TRUE; break;
1751 case DT_GNU_HASH: name = "GNU_HASH"; break;
1754 fprintf (f, " %-20s ", name);
1758 bfd_fprintf_vma (abfd, f, dyn.d_un.d_val);
1763 unsigned int tagv = dyn.d_un.d_val;
1765 string = bfd_elf_string_from_elf_section (abfd, shlink, tagv);
1768 fprintf (f, "%s", string);
1777 if ((elf_dynverdef (abfd) != 0 && elf_tdata (abfd)->verdef == NULL)
1778 || (elf_dynverref (abfd) != 0 && elf_tdata (abfd)->verref == NULL))
1780 if (! _bfd_elf_slurp_version_tables (abfd, FALSE))
1784 if (elf_dynverdef (abfd) != 0)
1786 Elf_Internal_Verdef *t;
1788 fprintf (f, _("\nVersion definitions:\n"));
1789 for (t = elf_tdata (abfd)->verdef; t != NULL; t = t->vd_nextdef)
1791 fprintf (f, "%d 0x%2.2x 0x%8.8lx %s\n", t->vd_ndx,
1792 t->vd_flags, t->vd_hash,
1793 t->vd_nodename ? t->vd_nodename : "<corrupt>");
1794 if (t->vd_auxptr != NULL && t->vd_auxptr->vda_nextptr != NULL)
1796 Elf_Internal_Verdaux *a;
1799 for (a = t->vd_auxptr->vda_nextptr;
1803 a->vda_nodename ? a->vda_nodename : "<corrupt>");
1809 if (elf_dynverref (abfd) != 0)
1811 Elf_Internal_Verneed *t;
1813 fprintf (f, _("\nVersion References:\n"));
1814 for (t = elf_tdata (abfd)->verref; t != NULL; t = t->vn_nextref)
1816 Elf_Internal_Vernaux *a;
1818 fprintf (f, _(" required from %s:\n"),
1819 t->vn_filename ? t->vn_filename : "<corrupt>");
1820 for (a = t->vn_auxptr; a != NULL; a = a->vna_nextptr)
1821 fprintf (f, " 0x%8.8lx 0x%2.2x %2.2d %s\n", a->vna_hash,
1822 a->vna_flags, a->vna_other,
1823 a->vna_nodename ? a->vna_nodename : "<corrupt>");
1835 /* Get version string. */
1838 _bfd_elf_get_symbol_version_string (bfd *abfd, asymbol *symbol,
1839 bfd_boolean *hidden)
1841 const char *version_string = NULL;
1842 if (elf_dynversym (abfd) != 0
1843 && (elf_dynverdef (abfd) != 0 || elf_dynverref (abfd) != 0))
1845 unsigned int vernum = ((elf_symbol_type *) symbol)->version;
1847 *hidden = (vernum & VERSYM_HIDDEN) != 0;
1848 vernum &= VERSYM_VERSION;
1851 version_string = "";
1852 else if (vernum == 1)
1853 version_string = "Base";
1854 else if (vernum <= elf_tdata (abfd)->cverdefs)
1856 elf_tdata (abfd)->verdef[vernum - 1].vd_nodename;
1859 Elf_Internal_Verneed *t;
1861 version_string = "";
1862 for (t = elf_tdata (abfd)->verref;
1866 Elf_Internal_Vernaux *a;
1868 for (a = t->vn_auxptr; a != NULL; a = a->vna_nextptr)
1870 if (a->vna_other == vernum)
1872 version_string = a->vna_nodename;
1879 return version_string;
1882 /* Display ELF-specific fields of a symbol. */
1885 bfd_elf_print_symbol (bfd *abfd,
1888 bfd_print_symbol_type how)
1890 FILE *file = (FILE *) filep;
1893 case bfd_print_symbol_name:
1894 fprintf (file, "%s", symbol->name);
1896 case bfd_print_symbol_more:
1897 fprintf (file, "elf ");
1898 bfd_fprintf_vma (abfd, file, symbol->value);
1899 fprintf (file, " %x", symbol->flags);
1901 case bfd_print_symbol_all:
1903 const char *section_name;
1904 const char *name = NULL;
1905 const struct elf_backend_data *bed;
1906 unsigned char st_other;
1908 const char *version_string;
1911 section_name = symbol->section ? symbol->section->name : "(*none*)";
1913 bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
1914 if (bed->elf_backend_print_symbol_all)
1915 name = (*bed->elf_backend_print_symbol_all) (abfd, filep, symbol);
1919 name = symbol->name;
1920 bfd_print_symbol_vandf (abfd, file, symbol);
1923 fprintf (file, " %s\t", section_name);
1924 /* Print the "other" value for a symbol. For common symbols,
1925 we've already printed the size; now print the alignment.
1926 For other symbols, we have no specified alignment, and
1927 we've printed the address; now print the size. */
1928 if (symbol->section && bfd_is_com_section (symbol->section))
1929 val = ((elf_symbol_type *) symbol)->internal_elf_sym.st_value;
1931 val = ((elf_symbol_type *) symbol)->internal_elf_sym.st_size;
1932 bfd_fprintf_vma (abfd, file, val);
1934 /* If we have version information, print it. */
1935 version_string = _bfd_elf_get_symbol_version_string (abfd,
1941 fprintf (file, " %-11s", version_string);
1946 fprintf (file, " (%s)", version_string);
1947 for (i = 10 - strlen (version_string); i > 0; --i)
1952 /* If the st_other field is not zero, print it. */
1953 st_other = ((elf_symbol_type *) symbol)->internal_elf_sym.st_other;
1958 case STV_INTERNAL: fprintf (file, " .internal"); break;
1959 case STV_HIDDEN: fprintf (file, " .hidden"); break;
1960 case STV_PROTECTED: fprintf (file, " .protected"); break;
1962 /* Some other non-defined flags are also present, so print
1964 fprintf (file, " 0x%02x", (unsigned int) st_other);
1967 fprintf (file, " %s", name);
1973 /* ELF .o/exec file reading */
1975 /* Create a new bfd section from an ELF section header. */
1978 bfd_section_from_shdr (bfd *abfd, unsigned int shindex)
1980 Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr;
1981 Elf_Internal_Ehdr *ehdr;
1982 const struct elf_backend_data *bed;
1984 bfd_boolean ret = TRUE;
1985 static bfd_boolean * sections_being_created = NULL;
1986 static bfd * sections_being_created_abfd = NULL;
1987 static unsigned int nesting = 0;
1989 if (shindex >= elf_numsections (abfd))
1994 /* PR17512: A corrupt ELF binary might contain a recursive group of
1995 sections, with each the string indicies pointing to the next in the
1996 loop. Detect this here, by refusing to load a section that we are
1997 already in the process of loading. We only trigger this test if
1998 we have nested at least three sections deep as normal ELF binaries
1999 can expect to recurse at least once.
2001 FIXME: It would be better if this array was attached to the bfd,
2002 rather than being held in a static pointer. */
2004 if (sections_being_created_abfd != abfd)
2005 sections_being_created = NULL;
2006 if (sections_being_created == NULL)
2008 /* FIXME: It would be more efficient to attach this array to the bfd somehow. */
2009 sections_being_created = (bfd_boolean *)
2010 bfd_zalloc (abfd, elf_numsections (abfd) * sizeof (bfd_boolean));
2011 sections_being_created_abfd = abfd;
2013 if (sections_being_created [shindex])
2016 (_("%B: warning: loop in section dependencies detected"), abfd);
2019 sections_being_created [shindex] = TRUE;
2022 hdr = elf_elfsections (abfd)[shindex];
2023 ehdr = elf_elfheader (abfd);
2024 name = bfd_elf_string_from_elf_section (abfd, ehdr->e_shstrndx,
2029 bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
2030 switch (hdr->sh_type)
2033 /* Inactive section. Throw it away. */
2036 case SHT_PROGBITS: /* Normal section with contents. */
2037 case SHT_NOBITS: /* .bss section. */
2038 case SHT_HASH: /* .hash section. */
2039 case SHT_NOTE: /* .note section. */
2040 case SHT_INIT_ARRAY: /* .init_array section. */
2041 case SHT_FINI_ARRAY: /* .fini_array section. */
2042 case SHT_PREINIT_ARRAY: /* .preinit_array section. */
2043 case SHT_GNU_LIBLIST: /* .gnu.liblist section. */
2044 case SHT_GNU_HASH: /* .gnu.hash section. */
2045 ret = _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name, shindex);
2048 case SHT_DYNAMIC: /* Dynamic linking information. */
2049 if (! _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name, shindex))
2052 if (hdr->sh_link > elf_numsections (abfd))
2054 /* PR 10478: Accept Solaris binaries with a sh_link
2055 field set to SHN_BEFORE or SHN_AFTER. */
2056 switch (bfd_get_arch (abfd))
2059 case bfd_arch_sparc:
2060 if (hdr->sh_link == (SHN_LORESERVE & 0xffff) /* SHN_BEFORE */
2061 || hdr->sh_link == ((SHN_LORESERVE + 1) & 0xffff) /* SHN_AFTER */)
2063 /* Otherwise fall through. */
2068 else if (elf_elfsections (abfd)[hdr->sh_link] == NULL)
2070 else if (elf_elfsections (abfd)[hdr->sh_link]->sh_type != SHT_STRTAB)
2072 Elf_Internal_Shdr *dynsymhdr;
2074 /* The shared libraries distributed with hpux11 have a bogus
2075 sh_link field for the ".dynamic" section. Find the
2076 string table for the ".dynsym" section instead. */
2077 if (elf_dynsymtab (abfd) != 0)
2079 dynsymhdr = elf_elfsections (abfd)[elf_dynsymtab (abfd)];
2080 hdr->sh_link = dynsymhdr->sh_link;
2084 unsigned int i, num_sec;
2086 num_sec = elf_numsections (abfd);
2087 for (i = 1; i < num_sec; i++)
2089 dynsymhdr = elf_elfsections (abfd)[i];
2090 if (dynsymhdr->sh_type == SHT_DYNSYM)
2092 hdr->sh_link = dynsymhdr->sh_link;
2100 case SHT_SYMTAB: /* A symbol table. */
2101 if (elf_onesymtab (abfd) == shindex)
2104 if (hdr->sh_entsize != bed->s->sizeof_sym)
2107 if (hdr->sh_info * hdr->sh_entsize > hdr->sh_size)
2109 if (hdr->sh_size != 0)
2111 /* Some assemblers erroneously set sh_info to one with a
2112 zero sh_size. ld sees this as a global symbol count
2113 of (unsigned) -1. Fix it here. */
2118 /* PR 18854: A binary might contain more than one symbol table.
2119 Unusual, but possible. Warn, but continue. */
2120 if (elf_onesymtab (abfd) != 0)
2123 /* xgettext:c-format */
2124 (_("%B: warning: multiple symbol tables detected"
2125 " - ignoring the table in section %u"),
2129 elf_onesymtab (abfd) = shindex;
2130 elf_symtab_hdr (abfd) = *hdr;
2131 elf_elfsections (abfd)[shindex] = hdr = & elf_symtab_hdr (abfd);
2132 abfd->flags |= HAS_SYMS;
2134 /* Sometimes a shared object will map in the symbol table. If
2135 SHF_ALLOC is set, and this is a shared object, then we also
2136 treat this section as a BFD section. We can not base the
2137 decision purely on SHF_ALLOC, because that flag is sometimes
2138 set in a relocatable object file, which would confuse the
2140 if ((hdr->sh_flags & SHF_ALLOC) != 0
2141 && (abfd->flags & DYNAMIC) != 0
2142 && ! _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name,
2146 /* Go looking for SHT_SYMTAB_SHNDX too, since if there is one we
2147 can't read symbols without that section loaded as well. It
2148 is most likely specified by the next section header. */
2150 elf_section_list * entry;
2151 unsigned int i, num_sec;
2153 for (entry = elf_symtab_shndx_list (abfd); entry != NULL; entry = entry->next)
2154 if (entry->hdr.sh_link == shindex)
2157 num_sec = elf_numsections (abfd);
2158 for (i = shindex + 1; i < num_sec; i++)
2160 Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr2 = elf_elfsections (abfd)[i];
2162 if (hdr2->sh_type == SHT_SYMTAB_SHNDX
2163 && hdr2->sh_link == shindex)
2168 for (i = 1; i < shindex; i++)
2170 Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr2 = elf_elfsections (abfd)[i];
2172 if (hdr2->sh_type == SHT_SYMTAB_SHNDX
2173 && hdr2->sh_link == shindex)
2178 ret = bfd_section_from_shdr (abfd, i);
2179 /* else FIXME: we have failed to find the symbol table - should we issue an error ? */
2183 case SHT_DYNSYM: /* A dynamic symbol table. */
2184 if (elf_dynsymtab (abfd) == shindex)
2187 if (hdr->sh_entsize != bed->s->sizeof_sym)
2190 if (hdr->sh_info * hdr->sh_entsize > hdr->sh_size)
2192 if (hdr->sh_size != 0)
2195 /* Some linkers erroneously set sh_info to one with a
2196 zero sh_size. ld sees this as a global symbol count
2197 of (unsigned) -1. Fix it here. */
2202 /* PR 18854: A binary might contain more than one dynamic symbol table.
2203 Unusual, but possible. Warn, but continue. */
2204 if (elf_dynsymtab (abfd) != 0)
2207 /* xgettext:c-format */
2208 (_("%B: warning: multiple dynamic symbol tables detected"
2209 " - ignoring the table in section %u"),
2213 elf_dynsymtab (abfd) = shindex;
2214 elf_tdata (abfd)->dynsymtab_hdr = *hdr;
2215 elf_elfsections (abfd)[shindex] = hdr = &elf_tdata (abfd)->dynsymtab_hdr;
2216 abfd->flags |= HAS_SYMS;
2218 /* Besides being a symbol table, we also treat this as a regular
2219 section, so that objcopy can handle it. */
2220 ret = _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name, shindex);
2223 case SHT_SYMTAB_SHNDX: /* Symbol section indices when >64k sections. */
2225 elf_section_list * entry;
2227 for (entry = elf_symtab_shndx_list (abfd); entry != NULL; entry = entry->next)
2228 if (entry->ndx == shindex)
2231 entry = bfd_alloc (abfd, sizeof * entry);
2234 entry->ndx = shindex;
2236 entry->next = elf_symtab_shndx_list (abfd);
2237 elf_symtab_shndx_list (abfd) = entry;
2238 elf_elfsections (abfd)[shindex] = & entry->hdr;
2242 case SHT_STRTAB: /* A string table. */
2243 if (hdr->bfd_section != NULL)
2246 if (ehdr->e_shstrndx == shindex)
2248 elf_tdata (abfd)->shstrtab_hdr = *hdr;
2249 elf_elfsections (abfd)[shindex] = &elf_tdata (abfd)->shstrtab_hdr;
2253 if (elf_elfsections (abfd)[elf_onesymtab (abfd)]->sh_link == shindex)
2256 elf_tdata (abfd)->strtab_hdr = *hdr;
2257 elf_elfsections (abfd)[shindex] = &elf_tdata (abfd)->strtab_hdr;
2261 if (elf_elfsections (abfd)[elf_dynsymtab (abfd)]->sh_link == shindex)
2264 elf_tdata (abfd)->dynstrtab_hdr = *hdr;
2265 hdr = &elf_tdata (abfd)->dynstrtab_hdr;
2266 elf_elfsections (abfd)[shindex] = hdr;
2267 /* We also treat this as a regular section, so that objcopy
2269 ret = _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name,
2274 /* If the string table isn't one of the above, then treat it as a
2275 regular section. We need to scan all the headers to be sure,
2276 just in case this strtab section appeared before the above. */
2277 if (elf_onesymtab (abfd) == 0 || elf_dynsymtab (abfd) == 0)
2279 unsigned int i, num_sec;
2281 num_sec = elf_numsections (abfd);
2282 for (i = 1; i < num_sec; i++)
2284 Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr2 = elf_elfsections (abfd)[i];
2285 if (hdr2->sh_link == shindex)
2287 /* Prevent endless recursion on broken objects. */
2290 if (! bfd_section_from_shdr (abfd, i))
2292 if (elf_onesymtab (abfd) == i)
2294 if (elf_dynsymtab (abfd) == i)
2295 goto dynsymtab_strtab;
2299 ret = _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name, shindex);
2304 /* *These* do a lot of work -- but build no sections! */
2306 asection *target_sect;
2307 Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr2, **p_hdr;
2308 unsigned int num_sec = elf_numsections (abfd);
2309 struct bfd_elf_section_data *esdt;
2312 != (bfd_size_type) (hdr->sh_type == SHT_REL
2313 ? bed->s->sizeof_rel : bed->s->sizeof_rela))
2316 /* Check for a bogus link to avoid crashing. */
2317 if (hdr->sh_link >= num_sec)
2320 /* xgettext:c-format */
2321 (_("%B: invalid link %u for reloc section %s (index %u)"),
2322 abfd, hdr->sh_link, name, shindex);
2323 ret = _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name,
2328 /* For some incomprehensible reason Oracle distributes
2329 libraries for Solaris in which some of the objects have
2330 bogus sh_link fields. It would be nice if we could just
2331 reject them, but, unfortunately, some people need to use
2332 them. We scan through the section headers; if we find only
2333 one suitable symbol table, we clobber the sh_link to point
2334 to it. I hope this doesn't break anything.
2336 Don't do it on executable nor shared library. */
2337 if ((abfd->flags & (DYNAMIC | EXEC_P)) == 0
2338 && elf_elfsections (abfd)[hdr->sh_link]->sh_type != SHT_SYMTAB
2339 && elf_elfsections (abfd)[hdr->sh_link]->sh_type != SHT_DYNSYM)
2345 for (scan = 1; scan < num_sec; scan++)
2347 if (elf_elfsections (abfd)[scan]->sh_type == SHT_SYMTAB
2348 || elf_elfsections (abfd)[scan]->sh_type == SHT_DYNSYM)
2359 hdr->sh_link = found;
2362 /* Get the symbol table. */
2363 if ((elf_elfsections (abfd)[hdr->sh_link]->sh_type == SHT_SYMTAB
2364 || elf_elfsections (abfd)[hdr->sh_link]->sh_type == SHT_DYNSYM)
2365 && ! bfd_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr->sh_link))
2368 /* If this reloc section does not use the main symbol table we
2369 don't treat it as a reloc section. BFD can't adequately
2370 represent such a section, so at least for now, we don't
2371 try. We just present it as a normal section. We also
2372 can't use it as a reloc section if it points to the null
2373 section, an invalid section, another reloc section, or its
2374 sh_link points to the null section. */
2375 if (hdr->sh_link != elf_onesymtab (abfd)
2376 || hdr->sh_link == SHN_UNDEF
2377 || hdr->sh_info == SHN_UNDEF
2378 || hdr->sh_info >= num_sec
2379 || elf_elfsections (abfd)[hdr->sh_info]->sh_type == SHT_REL
2380 || elf_elfsections (abfd)[hdr->sh_info]->sh_type == SHT_RELA)
2382 ret = _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name,
2387 if (! bfd_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr->sh_info))
2390 target_sect = bfd_section_from_elf_index (abfd, hdr->sh_info);
2391 if (target_sect == NULL)
2394 esdt = elf_section_data (target_sect);
2395 if (hdr->sh_type == SHT_RELA)
2396 p_hdr = &esdt->rela.hdr;
2398 p_hdr = &esdt->rel.hdr;
2400 /* PR 17512: file: 0b4f81b7. */
2403 hdr2 = (Elf_Internal_Shdr *) bfd_alloc (abfd, sizeof (*hdr2));
2408 elf_elfsections (abfd)[shindex] = hdr2;
2409 target_sect->reloc_count += (NUM_SHDR_ENTRIES (hdr)
2410 * bed->s->int_rels_per_ext_rel);
2411 target_sect->flags |= SEC_RELOC;
2412 target_sect->relocation = NULL;
2413 target_sect->rel_filepos = hdr->sh_offset;
2414 /* In the section to which the relocations apply, mark whether
2415 its relocations are of the REL or RELA variety. */
2416 if (hdr->sh_size != 0)
2418 if (hdr->sh_type == SHT_RELA)
2419 target_sect->use_rela_p = 1;
2421 abfd->flags |= HAS_RELOC;
2425 case SHT_GNU_verdef:
2426 elf_dynverdef (abfd) = shindex;
2427 elf_tdata (abfd)->dynverdef_hdr = *hdr;
2428 ret = _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name, shindex);
2431 case SHT_GNU_versym:
2432 if (hdr->sh_entsize != sizeof (Elf_External_Versym))
2435 elf_dynversym (abfd) = shindex;
2436 elf_tdata (abfd)->dynversym_hdr = *hdr;
2437 ret = _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name, shindex);
2440 case SHT_GNU_verneed:
2441 elf_dynverref (abfd) = shindex;
2442 elf_tdata (abfd)->dynverref_hdr = *hdr;
2443 ret = _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name, shindex);
2450 if (! IS_VALID_GROUP_SECTION_HEADER (hdr, GRP_ENTRY_SIZE))
2453 if (!_bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name, shindex))
2459 /* Possibly an attributes section. */
2460 if (hdr->sh_type == SHT_GNU_ATTRIBUTES
2461 || hdr->sh_type == bed->obj_attrs_section_type)
2463 if (! _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name, shindex))
2465 _bfd_elf_parse_attributes (abfd, hdr);
2469 /* Check for any processor-specific section types. */
2470 if (bed->elf_backend_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name, shindex))
2473 if (hdr->sh_type >= SHT_LOUSER && hdr->sh_type <= SHT_HIUSER)
2475 if ((hdr->sh_flags & SHF_ALLOC) != 0)
2476 /* FIXME: How to properly handle allocated section reserved
2477 for applications? */
2479 /* xgettext:c-format */
2480 (_("%B: unknown type [%#x] section `%s'"),
2481 abfd, hdr->sh_type, name);
2484 /* Allow sections reserved for applications. */
2485 ret = _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name,
2490 else if (hdr->sh_type >= SHT_LOPROC
2491 && hdr->sh_type <= SHT_HIPROC)
2492 /* FIXME: We should handle this section. */
2494 /* xgettext:c-format */
2495 (_("%B: unknown type [%#x] section `%s'"),
2496 abfd, hdr->sh_type, name);
2497 else if (hdr->sh_type >= SHT_LOOS && hdr->sh_type <= SHT_HIOS)
2499 /* Unrecognised OS-specific sections. */
2500 if ((hdr->sh_flags & SHF_OS_NONCONFORMING) != 0)
2501 /* SHF_OS_NONCONFORMING indicates that special knowledge is
2502 required to correctly process the section and the file should
2503 be rejected with an error message. */
2505 /* xgettext:c-format */
2506 (_("%B: unknown type [%#x] section `%s'"),
2507 abfd, hdr->sh_type, name);
2510 /* Otherwise it should be processed. */
2511 ret = _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name, shindex);
2516 /* FIXME: We should handle this section. */
2518 /* xgettext:c-format */
2519 (_("%B: unknown type [%#x] section `%s'"),
2520 abfd, hdr->sh_type, name);
2528 if (sections_being_created && sections_being_created_abfd == abfd)
2529 sections_being_created [shindex] = FALSE;
2530 if (-- nesting == 0)
2532 sections_being_created = NULL;
2533 sections_being_created_abfd = abfd;
2538 /* Return the local symbol specified by ABFD, R_SYMNDX. */
2541 bfd_sym_from_r_symndx (struct sym_cache *cache,
2543 unsigned long r_symndx)
2545 unsigned int ent = r_symndx % LOCAL_SYM_CACHE_SIZE;
2547 if (cache->abfd != abfd || cache->indx[ent] != r_symndx)
2549 Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr;
2550 unsigned char esym[sizeof (Elf64_External_Sym)];
2551 Elf_External_Sym_Shndx eshndx;
2553 symtab_hdr = &elf_tdata (abfd)->symtab_hdr;
2554 if (bfd_elf_get_elf_syms (abfd, symtab_hdr, 1, r_symndx,
2555 &cache->sym[ent], esym, &eshndx) == NULL)
2558 if (cache->abfd != abfd)
2560 memset (cache->indx, -1, sizeof (cache->indx));
2563 cache->indx[ent] = r_symndx;
2566 return &cache->sym[ent];
2569 /* Given an ELF section number, retrieve the corresponding BFD
2573 bfd_section_from_elf_index (bfd *abfd, unsigned int sec_index)
2575 if (sec_index >= elf_numsections (abfd))
2577 return elf_elfsections (abfd)[sec_index]->bfd_section;
2580 static const struct bfd_elf_special_section special_sections_b[] =
2582 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".bss"), -2, SHT_NOBITS, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_WRITE },
2583 { NULL, 0, 0, 0, 0 }
2586 static const struct bfd_elf_special_section special_sections_c[] =
2588 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".comment"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, 0 },
2589 { NULL, 0, 0, 0, 0 }
2592 static const struct bfd_elf_special_section special_sections_d[] =
2594 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".data"), -2, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_WRITE },
2595 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".data1"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_WRITE },
2596 /* There are more DWARF sections than these, but they needn't be added here
2597 unless you have to cope with broken compilers that don't emit section
2598 attributes or you want to help the user writing assembler. */
2599 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".debug"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, 0 },
2600 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".debug_line"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, 0 },
2601 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".debug_info"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, 0 },
2602 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".debug_abbrev"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, 0 },
2603 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".debug_aranges"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, 0 },
2604 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".dynamic"), 0, SHT_DYNAMIC, SHF_ALLOC },
2605 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".dynstr"), 0, SHT_STRTAB, SHF_ALLOC },
2606 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".dynsym"), 0, SHT_DYNSYM, SHF_ALLOC },
2607 { NULL, 0, 0, 0, 0 }
2610 static const struct bfd_elf_special_section special_sections_f[] =
2612 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".fini"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_EXECINSTR },
2613 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".fini_array"), -2, SHT_FINI_ARRAY, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_WRITE },
2614 { NULL, 0 , 0, 0, 0 }
2617 static const struct bfd_elf_special_section special_sections_g[] =
2619 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".gnu.linkonce.b"), -2, SHT_NOBITS, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_WRITE },
2620 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".gnu.lto_"), -1, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_EXCLUDE },
2621 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".got"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_WRITE },
2622 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".gnu.version"), 0, SHT_GNU_versym, 0 },
2623 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".gnu.version_d"), 0, SHT_GNU_verdef, 0 },
2624 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".gnu.version_r"), 0, SHT_GNU_verneed, 0 },
2625 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".gnu.liblist"), 0, SHT_GNU_LIBLIST, SHF_ALLOC },
2626 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".gnu.conflict"), 0, SHT_RELA, SHF_ALLOC },
2627 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".gnu.hash"), 0, SHT_GNU_HASH, SHF_ALLOC },
2628 { NULL, 0, 0, 0, 0 }
2631 static const struct bfd_elf_special_section special_sections_h[] =
2633 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".hash"), 0, SHT_HASH, SHF_ALLOC },
2634 { NULL, 0, 0, 0, 0 }
2637 static const struct bfd_elf_special_section special_sections_i[] =
2639 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".init"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_EXECINSTR },
2640 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".init_array"), -2, SHT_INIT_ARRAY, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_WRITE },
2641 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".interp"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, 0 },
2642 { NULL, 0, 0, 0, 0 }
2645 static const struct bfd_elf_special_section special_sections_l[] =
2647 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".line"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, 0 },
2648 { NULL, 0, 0, 0, 0 }
2651 static const struct bfd_elf_special_section special_sections_n[] =
2653 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".note.GNU-stack"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, 0 },
2654 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".note"), -1, SHT_NOTE, 0 },
2655 { NULL, 0, 0, 0, 0 }
2658 static const struct bfd_elf_special_section special_sections_p[] =
2660 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".preinit_array"), -2, SHT_PREINIT_ARRAY, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_WRITE },
2661 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".plt"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_EXECINSTR },
2662 { NULL, 0, 0, 0, 0 }
2665 static const struct bfd_elf_special_section special_sections_r[] =
2667 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".rodata"), -2, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC },
2668 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".rodata1"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC },
2669 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".rela"), -1, SHT_RELA, 0 },
2670 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".rel"), -1, SHT_REL, 0 },
2671 { NULL, 0, 0, 0, 0 }
2674 static const struct bfd_elf_special_section special_sections_s[] =
2676 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".shstrtab"), 0, SHT_STRTAB, 0 },
2677 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".strtab"), 0, SHT_STRTAB, 0 },
2678 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".symtab"), 0, SHT_SYMTAB, 0 },
2679 /* See struct bfd_elf_special_section declaration for the semantics of
2680 this special case where .prefix_length != strlen (.prefix). */
2681 { ".stabstr", 5, 3, SHT_STRTAB, 0 },
2682 { NULL, 0, 0, 0, 0 }
2685 static const struct bfd_elf_special_section special_sections_t[] =
2687 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".text"), -2, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_EXECINSTR },
2688 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".tbss"), -2, SHT_NOBITS, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_WRITE + SHF_TLS },
2689 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".tdata"), -2, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_WRITE + SHF_TLS },
2690 { NULL, 0, 0, 0, 0 }
2693 static const struct bfd_elf_special_section special_sections_z[] =
2695 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".zdebug_line"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, 0 },
2696 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".zdebug_info"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, 0 },
2697 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".zdebug_abbrev"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, 0 },
2698 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".zdebug_aranges"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, 0 },
2699 { NULL, 0, 0, 0, 0 }
2702 static const struct bfd_elf_special_section * const special_sections[] =
2704 special_sections_b, /* 'b' */
2705 special_sections_c, /* 'c' */
2706 special_sections_d, /* 'd' */
2708 special_sections_f, /* 'f' */
2709 special_sections_g, /* 'g' */
2710 special_sections_h, /* 'h' */
2711 special_sections_i, /* 'i' */
2714 special_sections_l, /* 'l' */
2716 special_sections_n, /* 'n' */
2718 special_sections_p, /* 'p' */
2720 special_sections_r, /* 'r' */
2721 special_sections_s, /* 's' */
2722 special_sections_t, /* 't' */
2728 special_sections_z /* 'z' */
2731 const struct bfd_elf_special_section *
2732 _bfd_elf_get_special_section (const char *name,
2733 const struct bfd_elf_special_section *spec,
2739 len = strlen (name);
2741 for (i = 0; spec[i].prefix != NULL; i++)
2744 int prefix_len = spec[i].prefix_length;
2746 if (len < prefix_len)
2748 if (memcmp (name, spec[i].prefix, prefix_len) != 0)
2751 suffix_len = spec[i].suffix_length;
2752 if (suffix_len <= 0)
2754 if (name[prefix_len] != 0)
2756 if (suffix_len == 0)
2758 if (name[prefix_len] != '.'
2759 && (suffix_len == -2
2760 || (rela && spec[i].type == SHT_REL)))
2766 if (len < prefix_len + suffix_len)
2768 if (memcmp (name + len - suffix_len,
2769 spec[i].prefix + prefix_len,
2779 const struct bfd_elf_special_section *
2780 _bfd_elf_get_sec_type_attr (bfd *abfd, asection *sec)
2783 const struct bfd_elf_special_section *spec;
2784 const struct elf_backend_data *bed;
2786 /* See if this is one of the special sections. */
2787 if (sec->name == NULL)
2790 bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
2791 spec = bed->special_sections;
2794 spec = _bfd_elf_get_special_section (sec->name,
2795 bed->special_sections,
2801 if (sec->name[0] != '.')
2804 i = sec->name[1] - 'b';
2805 if (i < 0 || i > 'z' - 'b')
2808 spec = special_sections[i];
2813 return _bfd_elf_get_special_section (sec->name, spec, sec->use_rela_p);
2817 _bfd_elf_new_section_hook (bfd *abfd, asection *sec)
2819 struct bfd_elf_section_data *sdata;
2820 const struct elf_backend_data *bed;
2821 const struct bfd_elf_special_section *ssect;
2823 sdata = (struct bfd_elf_section_data *) sec->used_by_bfd;
2826 sdata = (struct bfd_elf_section_data *) bfd_zalloc (abfd,
2830 sec->used_by_bfd = sdata;
2833 /* Indicate whether or not this section should use RELA relocations. */
2834 bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
2835 sec->use_rela_p = bed->default_use_rela_p;
2837 /* When we read a file, we don't need to set ELF section type and
2838 flags. They will be overridden in _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr
2839 anyway. We will set ELF section type and flags for all linker
2840 created sections. If user specifies BFD section flags, we will
2841 set ELF section type and flags based on BFD section flags in
2842 elf_fake_sections. Special handling for .init_array/.fini_array
2843 output sections since they may contain .ctors/.dtors input
2844 sections. We don't want _bfd_elf_init_private_section_data to
2845 copy ELF section type from .ctors/.dtors input sections. */
2846 if (abfd->direction != read_direction
2847 || (sec->flags & SEC_LINKER_CREATED) != 0)
2849 ssect = (*bed->get_sec_type_attr) (abfd, sec);
2852 || (sec->flags & SEC_LINKER_CREATED) != 0
2853 || ssect->type == SHT_INIT_ARRAY
2854 || ssect->type == SHT_FINI_ARRAY))
2856 elf_section_type (sec) = ssect->type;
2857 elf_section_flags (sec) = ssect->attr;
2861 return _bfd_generic_new_section_hook (abfd, sec);
2864 /* Create a new bfd section from an ELF program header.
2866 Since program segments have no names, we generate a synthetic name
2867 of the form segment<NUM>, where NUM is generally the index in the
2868 program header table. For segments that are split (see below) we
2869 generate the names segment<NUM>a and segment<NUM>b.
2871 Note that some program segments may have a file size that is different than
2872 (less than) the memory size. All this means is that at execution the
2873 system must allocate the amount of memory specified by the memory size,
2874 but only initialize it with the first "file size" bytes read from the
2875 file. This would occur for example, with program segments consisting
2876 of combined data+bss.
2878 To handle the above situation, this routine generates TWO bfd sections
2879 for the single program segment. The first has the length specified by
2880 the file size of the segment, and the second has the length specified
2881 by the difference between the two sizes. In effect, the segment is split
2882 into its initialized and uninitialized parts.
2887 _bfd_elf_make_section_from_phdr (bfd *abfd,
2888 Elf_Internal_Phdr *hdr,
2890 const char *type_name)
2898 split = ((hdr->p_memsz > 0)
2899 && (hdr->p_filesz > 0)
2900 && (hdr->p_memsz > hdr->p_filesz));
2902 if (hdr->p_filesz > 0)
2904 sprintf (namebuf, "%s%d%s", type_name, hdr_index, split ? "a" : "");
2905 len = strlen (namebuf) + 1;
2906 name = (char *) bfd_alloc (abfd, len);
2909 memcpy (name, namebuf, len);
2910 newsect = bfd_make_section (abfd, name);
2911 if (newsect == NULL)
2913 newsect->vma = hdr->p_vaddr;
2914 newsect->lma = hdr->p_paddr;
2915 newsect->size = hdr->p_filesz;
2916 newsect->filepos = hdr->p_offset;
2917 newsect->flags |= SEC_HAS_CONTENTS;
2918 newsect->alignment_power = bfd_log2 (hdr->p_align);
2919 if (hdr->p_type == PT_LOAD)
2921 newsect->flags |= SEC_ALLOC;
2922 newsect->flags |= SEC_LOAD;
2923 if (hdr->p_flags & PF_X)
2925 /* FIXME: all we known is that it has execute PERMISSION,
2927 newsect->flags |= SEC_CODE;
2930 if (!(hdr->p_flags & PF_W))
2932 newsect->flags |= SEC_READONLY;
2936 if (hdr->p_memsz > hdr->p_filesz)
2940 sprintf (namebuf, "%s%d%s", type_name, hdr_index, split ? "b" : "");
2941 len = strlen (namebuf) + 1;
2942 name = (char *) bfd_alloc (abfd, len);
2945 memcpy (name, namebuf, len);
2946 newsect = bfd_make_section (abfd, name);
2947 if (newsect == NULL)
2949 newsect->vma = hdr->p_vaddr + hdr->p_filesz;
2950 newsect->lma = hdr->p_paddr + hdr->p_filesz;
2951 newsect->size = hdr->p_memsz - hdr->p_filesz;
2952 newsect->filepos = hdr->p_offset + hdr->p_filesz;
2953 align = newsect->vma & -newsect->vma;
2954 if (align == 0 || align > hdr->p_align)
2955 align = hdr->p_align;
2956 newsect->alignment_power = bfd_log2 (align);
2957 if (hdr->p_type == PT_LOAD)
2959 /* Hack for gdb. Segments that have not been modified do
2960 not have their contents written to a core file, on the
2961 assumption that a debugger can find the contents in the
2962 executable. We flag this case by setting the fake
2963 section size to zero. Note that "real" bss sections will
2964 always have their contents dumped to the core file. */
2965 if (bfd_get_format (abfd) == bfd_core)
2967 newsect->flags |= SEC_ALLOC;
2968 if (hdr->p_flags & PF_X)
2969 newsect->flags |= SEC_CODE;
2971 if (!(hdr->p_flags & PF_W))
2972 newsect->flags |= SEC_READONLY;
2979 bfd_section_from_phdr (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Phdr *hdr, int hdr_index)
2981 const struct elf_backend_data *bed;
2983 switch (hdr->p_type)
2986 return _bfd_elf_make_section_from_phdr (abfd, hdr, hdr_index, "null");
2989 return _bfd_elf_make_section_from_phdr (abfd, hdr, hdr_index, "load");
2992 return _bfd_elf_make_section_from_phdr (abfd, hdr, hdr_index, "dynamic");
2995 return _bfd_elf_make_section_from_phdr (abfd, hdr, hdr_index, "interp");
2998 if (! _bfd_elf_make_section_from_phdr (abfd, hdr, hdr_index, "note"))
3000 if (! elf_read_notes (abfd, hdr->p_offset, hdr->p_filesz,
3006 return _bfd_elf_make_section_from_phdr (abfd, hdr, hdr_index, "shlib");
3009 return _bfd_elf_make_section_from_phdr (abfd, hdr, hdr_index, "phdr");
3011 case PT_GNU_EH_FRAME:
3012 return _bfd_elf_make_section_from_phdr (abfd, hdr, hdr_index,
3016 return _bfd_elf_make_section_from_phdr (abfd, hdr, hdr_index, "stack");
3019 return _bfd_elf_make_section_from_phdr (abfd, hdr, hdr_index, "relro");
3022 /* Check for any processor-specific program segment types. */
3023 bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
3024 return bed->elf_backend_section_from_phdr (abfd, hdr, hdr_index, "proc");
3028 /* Return the REL_HDR for SEC, assuming there is only a single one, either
3032 _bfd_elf_single_rel_hdr (asection *sec)
3034 if (elf_section_data (sec)->rel.hdr)
3036 BFD_ASSERT (elf_section_data (sec)->rela.hdr == NULL);
3037 return elf_section_data (sec)->rel.hdr;
3040 return elf_section_data (sec)->rela.hdr;
3044 _bfd_elf_set_reloc_sh_name (bfd *abfd,
3045 Elf_Internal_Shdr *rel_hdr,
3046 const char *sec_name,
3047 bfd_boolean use_rela_p)
3049 char *name = (char *) bfd_alloc (abfd,
3050 sizeof ".rela" + strlen (sec_name));
3054 sprintf (name, "%s%s", use_rela_p ? ".rela" : ".rel", sec_name);
3056 (unsigned int) _bfd_elf_strtab_add (elf_shstrtab (abfd), name,
3058 if (rel_hdr->sh_name == (unsigned int) -1)
3064 /* Allocate and initialize a section-header for a new reloc section,
3065 containing relocations against ASECT. It is stored in RELDATA. If
3066 USE_RELA_P is TRUE, we use RELA relocations; otherwise, we use REL
3070 _bfd_elf_init_reloc_shdr (bfd *abfd,
3071 struct bfd_elf_section_reloc_data *reldata,
3072 const char *sec_name,
3073 bfd_boolean use_rela_p,
3074 bfd_boolean delay_st_name_p)
3076 Elf_Internal_Shdr *rel_hdr;
3077 const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
3079 BFD_ASSERT (reldata->hdr == NULL);
3080 rel_hdr = bfd_zalloc (abfd, sizeof (*rel_hdr));
3081 reldata->hdr = rel_hdr;
3083 if (delay_st_name_p)
3084 rel_hdr->sh_name = (unsigned int) -1;
3085 else if (!_bfd_elf_set_reloc_sh_name (abfd, rel_hdr, sec_name,
3088 rel_hdr->sh_type = use_rela_p ? SHT_RELA : SHT_REL;
3089 rel_hdr->sh_entsize = (use_rela_p
3090 ? bed->s->sizeof_rela
3091 : bed->s->sizeof_rel);
3092 rel_hdr->sh_addralign = (bfd_vma) 1 << bed->s->log_file_align;
3093 rel_hdr->sh_flags = 0;
3094 rel_hdr->sh_addr = 0;
3095 rel_hdr->sh_size = 0;
3096 rel_hdr->sh_offset = 0;
3101 /* Return the default section type based on the passed in section flags. */
3104 bfd_elf_get_default_section_type (flagword flags)
3106 if ((flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0
3107 && (flags & (SEC_LOAD | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS)) == 0)
3109 return SHT_PROGBITS;
3112 struct fake_section_arg
3114 struct bfd_link_info *link_info;
3118 /* Set up an ELF internal section header for a section. */
3121 elf_fake_sections (bfd *abfd, asection *asect, void *fsarg)
3123 struct fake_section_arg *arg = (struct fake_section_arg *)fsarg;
3124 const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
3125 struct bfd_elf_section_data *esd = elf_section_data (asect);
3126 Elf_Internal_Shdr *this_hdr;
3127 unsigned int sh_type;
3128 const char *name = asect->name;
3129 bfd_boolean delay_st_name_p = FALSE;
3133 /* We already failed; just get out of the bfd_map_over_sections
3138 this_hdr = &esd->this_hdr;
3142 /* ld: compress DWARF debug sections with names: .debug_*. */
3143 if ((arg->link_info->compress_debug & COMPRESS_DEBUG)
3144 && (asect->flags & SEC_DEBUGGING)
3148 /* Set SEC_ELF_COMPRESS to indicate this section should be
3150 asect->flags |= SEC_ELF_COMPRESS;
3152 /* If this section will be compressed, delay adding section
3153 name to section name section after it is compressed in
3154 _bfd_elf_assign_file_positions_for_non_load. */
3155 delay_st_name_p = TRUE;
3158 else if ((asect->flags & SEC_ELF_RENAME))
3160 /* objcopy: rename output DWARF debug section. */
3161 if ((abfd->flags & (BFD_DECOMPRESS | BFD_COMPRESS_GABI)))
3163 /* When we decompress or compress with SHF_COMPRESSED,
3164 convert section name from .zdebug_* to .debug_* if
3168 char *new_name = convert_zdebug_to_debug (abfd, name);
3169 if (new_name == NULL)
3177 else if (asect->compress_status == COMPRESS_SECTION_DONE)
3179 /* PR binutils/18087: Compression does not always make a
3180 section smaller. So only rename the section when
3181 compression has actually taken place. If input section
3182 name is .zdebug_*, we should never compress it again. */
3183 char *new_name = convert_debug_to_zdebug (abfd, name);
3184 if (new_name == NULL)
3189 BFD_ASSERT (name[1] != 'z');
3194 if (delay_st_name_p)
3195 this_hdr->sh_name = (unsigned int) -1;
3199 = (unsigned int) _bfd_elf_strtab_add (elf_shstrtab (abfd),
3201 if (this_hdr->sh_name == (unsigned int) -1)
3208 /* Don't clear sh_flags. Assembler may set additional bits. */
3210 if ((asect->flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0
3211 || asect->user_set_vma)
3212 this_hdr->sh_addr = asect->vma;
3214 this_hdr->sh_addr = 0;
3216 this_hdr->sh_offset = 0;
3217 this_hdr->sh_size = asect->size;
3218 this_hdr->sh_link = 0;
3219 /* PR 17512: file: 0eb809fe, 8b0535ee. */
3220 if (asect->alignment_power >= (sizeof (bfd_vma) * 8) - 1)
3223 /* xgettext:c-format */
3224 (_("%B: error: Alignment power %d of section `%A' is too big"),
3225 abfd, asect->alignment_power, asect);
3229 this_hdr->sh_addralign = (bfd_vma) 1 << asect->alignment_power;
3230 /* The sh_entsize and sh_info fields may have been set already by
3231 copy_private_section_data. */
3233 this_hdr->bfd_section = asect;
3234 this_hdr->contents = NULL;
3236 /* If the section type is unspecified, we set it based on
3238 if ((asect->flags & SEC_GROUP) != 0)
3239 sh_type = SHT_GROUP;
3241 sh_type = bfd_elf_get_default_section_type (asect->flags);
3243 if (this_hdr->sh_type == SHT_NULL)
3244 this_hdr->sh_type = sh_type;
3245 else if (this_hdr->sh_type == SHT_NOBITS
3246 && sh_type == SHT_PROGBITS
3247 && (asect->flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0)
3249 /* Warn if we are changing a NOBITS section to PROGBITS, but
3250 allow the link to proceed. This can happen when users link
3251 non-bss input sections to bss output sections, or emit data
3252 to a bss output section via a linker script. */
3254 (_("warning: section `%A' type changed to PROGBITS"), asect);
3255 this_hdr->sh_type = sh_type;
3258 switch (this_hdr->sh_type)
3269 case SHT_INIT_ARRAY:
3270 case SHT_FINI_ARRAY:
3271 case SHT_PREINIT_ARRAY:
3272 this_hdr->sh_entsize = bed->s->arch_size / 8;
3276 this_hdr->sh_entsize = bed->s->sizeof_hash_entry;
3280 this_hdr->sh_entsize = bed->s->sizeof_sym;
3284 this_hdr->sh_entsize = bed->s->sizeof_dyn;
3288 if (get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->may_use_rela_p)
3289 this_hdr->sh_entsize = bed->s->sizeof_rela;
3293 if (get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->may_use_rel_p)
3294 this_hdr->sh_entsize = bed->s->sizeof_rel;
3297 case SHT_GNU_versym:
3298 this_hdr->sh_entsize = sizeof (Elf_External_Versym);
3301 case SHT_GNU_verdef:
3302 this_hdr->sh_entsize = 0;
3303 /* objcopy or strip will copy over sh_info, but may not set
3304 cverdefs. The linker will set cverdefs, but sh_info will be
3306 if (this_hdr->sh_info == 0)
3307 this_hdr->sh_info = elf_tdata (abfd)->cverdefs;
3309 BFD_ASSERT (elf_tdata (abfd)->cverdefs == 0
3310 || this_hdr->sh_info == elf_tdata (abfd)->cverdefs);
3313 case SHT_GNU_verneed:
3314 this_hdr->sh_entsize = 0;
3315 /* objcopy or strip will copy over sh_info, but may not set
3316 cverrefs. The linker will set cverrefs, but sh_info will be
3318 if (this_hdr->sh_info == 0)
3319 this_hdr->sh_info = elf_tdata (abfd)->cverrefs;
3321 BFD_ASSERT (elf_tdata (abfd)->cverrefs == 0
3322 || this_hdr->sh_info == elf_tdata (abfd)->cverrefs);
3326 this_hdr->sh_entsize = GRP_ENTRY_SIZE;
3330 this_hdr->sh_entsize = bed->s->arch_size == 64 ? 0 : 4;
3334 if ((asect->flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0)
3335 this_hdr->sh_flags |= SHF_ALLOC;
3336 if ((asect->flags & SEC_READONLY) == 0)
3337 this_hdr->sh_flags |= SHF_WRITE;
3338 if ((asect->flags & SEC_CODE) != 0)
3339 this_hdr->sh_flags |= SHF_EXECINSTR;
3340 if ((asect->flags & SEC_MERGE) != 0)
3342 this_hdr->sh_flags |= SHF_MERGE;
3343 this_hdr->sh_entsize = asect->entsize;
3345 if ((asect->flags & SEC_STRINGS) != 0)
3346 this_hdr->sh_flags |= SHF_STRINGS;
3347 if ((asect->flags & SEC_GROUP) == 0 && elf_group_name (asect) != NULL)
3348 this_hdr->sh_flags |= SHF_GROUP;
3349 if ((asect->flags & SEC_THREAD_LOCAL) != 0)
3351 this_hdr->sh_flags |= SHF_TLS;
3352 if (asect->size == 0
3353 && (asect->flags & SEC_HAS_CONTENTS) == 0)
3355 struct bfd_link_order *o = asect->map_tail.link_order;
3357 this_hdr->sh_size = 0;
3360 this_hdr->sh_size = o->offset + o->size;
3361 if (this_hdr->sh_size != 0)
3362 this_hdr->sh_type = SHT_NOBITS;
3366 if ((asect->flags & (SEC_GROUP | SEC_EXCLUDE)) == SEC_EXCLUDE)
3367 this_hdr->sh_flags |= SHF_EXCLUDE;
3369 /* If the section has relocs, set up a section header for the
3370 SHT_REL[A] section. If two relocation sections are required for
3371 this section, it is up to the processor-specific back-end to
3372 create the other. */
3373 if ((asect->flags & SEC_RELOC) != 0)
3375 /* When doing a relocatable link, create both REL and RELA sections if
3378 /* Do the normal setup if we wouldn't create any sections here. */
3379 && esd->rel.count + esd->rela.count > 0
3380 && (bfd_link_relocatable (arg->link_info)
3381 || arg->link_info->emitrelocations))
3383 if (esd->rel.count && esd->rel.hdr == NULL
3384 && !_bfd_elf_init_reloc_shdr (abfd, &esd->rel, name,
3385 FALSE, delay_st_name_p))
3390 if (esd->rela.count && esd->rela.hdr == NULL
3391 && !_bfd_elf_init_reloc_shdr (abfd, &esd->rela, name,
3392 TRUE, delay_st_name_p))
3398 else if (!_bfd_elf_init_reloc_shdr (abfd,
3400 ? &esd->rela : &esd->rel),
3410 /* Check for processor-specific section types. */
3411 sh_type = this_hdr->sh_type;
3412 if (bed->elf_backend_fake_sections
3413 && !(*bed->elf_backend_fake_sections) (abfd, this_hdr, asect))
3419 if (sh_type == SHT_NOBITS && asect->size != 0)
3421 /* Don't change the header type from NOBITS if we are being
3422 called for objcopy --only-keep-debug. */
3423 this_hdr->sh_type = sh_type;
3427 /* Fill in the contents of a SHT_GROUP section. Called from
3428 _bfd_elf_compute_section_file_positions for gas, objcopy, and
3429 when ELF targets use the generic linker, ld. Called for ld -r
3430 from bfd_elf_final_link. */
3433 bfd_elf_set_group_contents (bfd *abfd, asection *sec, void *failedptrarg)
3435 bfd_boolean *failedptr = (bfd_boolean *) failedptrarg;
3436 asection *elt, *first;
3440 /* Ignore linker created group section. See elfNN_ia64_object_p in
3442 if (((sec->flags & (SEC_GROUP | SEC_LINKER_CREATED)) != SEC_GROUP)
3446 if (elf_section_data (sec)->this_hdr.sh_info == 0)
3448 unsigned long symindx = 0;
3450 /* elf_group_id will have been set up by objcopy and the
3452 if (elf_group_id (sec) != NULL)
3453 symindx = elf_group_id (sec)->udata.i;
3457 /* If called from the assembler, swap_out_syms will have set up
3458 elf_section_syms. */
3459 BFD_ASSERT (elf_section_syms (abfd) != NULL);
3460 symindx = elf_section_syms (abfd)[sec->index]->udata.i;
3462 elf_section_data (sec)->this_hdr.sh_info = symindx;
3464 else if (elf_section_data (sec)->this_hdr.sh_info == (unsigned int) -2)
3466 /* The ELF backend linker sets sh_info to -2 when the group
3467 signature symbol is global, and thus the index can't be
3468 set until all local symbols are output. */
3470 struct bfd_elf_section_data *sec_data;
3471 unsigned long symndx;
3472 unsigned long extsymoff;
3473 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h;
3475 /* The point of this little dance to the first SHF_GROUP section
3476 then back to the SHT_GROUP section is that this gets us to
3477 the SHT_GROUP in the input object. */
3478 igroup = elf_sec_group (elf_next_in_group (sec));
3479 sec_data = elf_section_data (igroup);
3480 symndx = sec_data->this_hdr.sh_info;
3482 if (!elf_bad_symtab (igroup->owner))
3484 Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr;
3486 symtab_hdr = &elf_tdata (igroup->owner)->symtab_hdr;
3487 extsymoff = symtab_hdr->sh_info;
3489 h = elf_sym_hashes (igroup->owner)[symndx - extsymoff];
3490 while (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_indirect
3491 || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_warning)
3492 h = (struct elf_link_hash_entry *) h->root.u.i.link;
3494 elf_section_data (sec)->this_hdr.sh_info = h->indx;
3497 /* The contents won't be allocated for "ld -r" or objcopy. */
3499 if (sec->contents == NULL)
3502 sec->contents = (unsigned char *) bfd_alloc (abfd, sec->size);
3504 /* Arrange for the section to be written out. */
3505 elf_section_data (sec)->this_hdr.contents = sec->contents;
3506 if (sec->contents == NULL)
3513 loc = sec->contents + sec->size;
3515 /* Get the pointer to the first section in the group that gas
3516 squirreled away here. objcopy arranges for this to be set to the
3517 start of the input section group. */
3518 first = elt = elf_next_in_group (sec);
3520 /* First element is a flag word. Rest of section is elf section
3521 indices for all the sections of the group. Write them backwards
3522 just to keep the group in the same order as given in .section
3523 directives, not that it matters. */
3530 s = s->output_section;
3532 && !bfd_is_abs_section (s))
3534 struct bfd_elf_section_data *elf_sec = elf_section_data (s);
3535 struct bfd_elf_section_data *input_elf_sec = elf_section_data (elt);
3537 if (elf_sec->rel.hdr != NULL
3539 || (input_elf_sec->rel.hdr != NULL
3540 && input_elf_sec->rel.hdr->sh_flags & SHF_GROUP) != 0))
3542 elf_sec->rel.hdr->sh_flags |= SHF_GROUP;
3544 H_PUT_32 (abfd, elf_sec->rel.idx, loc);
3546 if (elf_sec->rela.hdr != NULL
3548 || (input_elf_sec->rela.hdr != NULL
3549 && input_elf_sec->rela.hdr->sh_flags & SHF_GROUP) != 0))
3551 elf_sec->rela.hdr->sh_flags |= SHF_GROUP;
3553 H_PUT_32 (abfd, elf_sec->rela.idx, loc);
3556 H_PUT_32 (abfd, elf_sec->this_idx, loc);
3558 elt = elf_next_in_group (elt);
3564 BFD_ASSERT (loc == sec->contents);
3566 H_PUT_32 (abfd, sec->flags & SEC_LINK_ONCE ? GRP_COMDAT : 0, loc);
3569 /* Given NAME, the name of a relocation section stripped of its
3570 .rel/.rela prefix, return the section in ABFD to which the
3571 relocations apply. */
3574 _bfd_elf_plt_get_reloc_section (bfd *abfd, const char *name)
3576 /* If a target needs .got.plt section, relocations in rela.plt/rel.plt
3577 section likely apply to .got.plt or .got section. */
3578 if (get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->want_got_plt
3579 && strcmp (name, ".plt") == 0)
3584 sec = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, name);
3590 return bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, name);
3593 /* Return the section to which RELOC_SEC applies. */
3596 elf_get_reloc_section (asection *reloc_sec)
3601 const struct elf_backend_data *bed;
3603 type = elf_section_data (reloc_sec)->this_hdr.sh_type;
3604 if (type != SHT_REL && type != SHT_RELA)
3607 /* We look up the section the relocs apply to by name. */
3608 name = reloc_sec->name;
3609 if (strncmp (name, ".rel", 4) != 0)
3612 if (type == SHT_RELA && *name++ != 'a')
3615 abfd = reloc_sec->owner;
3616 bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
3617 return bed->get_reloc_section (abfd, name);
3620 /* Assign all ELF section numbers. The dummy first section is handled here
3621 too. The link/info pointers for the standard section types are filled
3622 in here too, while we're at it. */
3625 assign_section_numbers (bfd *abfd, struct bfd_link_info *link_info)
3627 struct elf_obj_tdata *t = elf_tdata (abfd);
3629 unsigned int section_number;
3630 Elf_Internal_Shdr **i_shdrp;
3631 struct bfd_elf_section_data *d;
3632 bfd_boolean need_symtab;
3636 _bfd_elf_strtab_clear_all_refs (elf_shstrtab (abfd));
3638 /* SHT_GROUP sections are in relocatable files only. */
3639 if (link_info == NULL || !link_info->resolve_section_groups)
3641 size_t reloc_count = 0;
3643 /* Put SHT_GROUP sections first. */
3644 for (sec = abfd->sections; sec != NULL; sec = sec->next)
3646 d = elf_section_data (sec);
3648 if (d->this_hdr.sh_type == SHT_GROUP)
3650 if (sec->flags & SEC_LINKER_CREATED)
3652 /* Remove the linker created SHT_GROUP sections. */
3653 bfd_section_list_remove (abfd, sec);
3654 abfd->section_count--;
3657 d->this_idx = section_number++;
3660 /* Count relocations. */
3661 reloc_count += sec->reloc_count;
3664 /* Clear HAS_RELOC if there are no relocations. */
3665 if (reloc_count == 0)
3666 abfd->flags &= ~HAS_RELOC;
3669 for (sec = abfd->sections; sec; sec = sec->next)
3671 d = elf_section_data (sec);
3673 if (d->this_hdr.sh_type != SHT_GROUP)
3674 d->this_idx = section_number++;
3675 if (d->this_hdr.sh_name != (unsigned int) -1)
3676 _bfd_elf_strtab_addref (elf_shstrtab (abfd), d->this_hdr.sh_name);
3679 d->rel.idx = section_number++;
3680 if (d->rel.hdr->sh_name != (unsigned int) -1)
3681 _bfd_elf_strtab_addref (elf_shstrtab (abfd), d->rel.hdr->sh_name);
3688 d->rela.idx = section_number++;
3689 if (d->rela.hdr->sh_name != (unsigned int) -1)
3690 _bfd_elf_strtab_addref (elf_shstrtab (abfd), d->rela.hdr->sh_name);
3696 need_symtab = (bfd_get_symcount (abfd) > 0
3697 || (link_info == NULL
3698 && ((abfd->flags & (EXEC_P | DYNAMIC | HAS_RELOC))
3702 elf_onesymtab (abfd) = section_number++;
3703 _bfd_elf_strtab_addref (elf_shstrtab (abfd), t->symtab_hdr.sh_name);
3704 if (section_number > ((SHN_LORESERVE - 2) & 0xFFFF))
3706 elf_section_list * entry;
3708 BFD_ASSERT (elf_symtab_shndx_list (abfd) == NULL);
3710 entry = bfd_zalloc (abfd, sizeof * entry);
3711 entry->ndx = section_number++;
3712 elf_symtab_shndx_list (abfd) = entry;
3714 = (unsigned int) _bfd_elf_strtab_add (elf_shstrtab (abfd),
3715 ".symtab_shndx", FALSE);
3716 if (entry->hdr.sh_name == (unsigned int) -1)
3719 elf_strtab_sec (abfd) = section_number++;
3720 _bfd_elf_strtab_addref (elf_shstrtab (abfd), t->strtab_hdr.sh_name);
3723 elf_shstrtab_sec (abfd) = section_number++;
3724 _bfd_elf_strtab_addref (elf_shstrtab (abfd), t->shstrtab_hdr.sh_name);
3725 elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_shstrndx = elf_shstrtab_sec (abfd);
3727 if (section_number >= SHN_LORESERVE)
3729 /* xgettext:c-format */
3730 _bfd_error_handler (_("%B: too many sections: %u"),
3731 abfd, section_number);
3735 elf_numsections (abfd) = section_number;
3736 elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_shnum = section_number;
3738 /* Set up the list of section header pointers, in agreement with the
3740 i_shdrp = (Elf_Internal_Shdr **) bfd_zalloc2 (abfd, section_number,
3741 sizeof (Elf_Internal_Shdr *));
3742 if (i_shdrp == NULL)
3745 i_shdrp[0] = (Elf_Internal_Shdr *) bfd_zalloc (abfd,
3746 sizeof (Elf_Internal_Shdr));
3747 if (i_shdrp[0] == NULL)
3749 bfd_release (abfd, i_shdrp);
3753 elf_elfsections (abfd) = i_shdrp;
3755 i_shdrp[elf_shstrtab_sec (abfd)] = &t->shstrtab_hdr;
3758 i_shdrp[elf_onesymtab (abfd)] = &t->symtab_hdr;
3759 if (elf_numsections (abfd) > (SHN_LORESERVE & 0xFFFF))
3761 elf_section_list * entry = elf_symtab_shndx_list (abfd);
3762 BFD_ASSERT (entry != NULL);
3763 i_shdrp[entry->ndx] = & entry->hdr;
3764 entry->hdr.sh_link = elf_onesymtab (abfd);
3766 i_shdrp[elf_strtab_sec (abfd)] = &t->strtab_hdr;
3767 t->symtab_hdr.sh_link = elf_strtab_sec (abfd);
3770 for (sec = abfd->sections; sec; sec = sec->next)
3774 d = elf_section_data (sec);
3776 i_shdrp[d->this_idx] = &d->this_hdr;
3777 if (d->rel.idx != 0)
3778 i_shdrp[d->rel.idx] = d->rel.hdr;
3779 if (d->rela.idx != 0)
3780 i_shdrp[d->rela.idx] = d->rela.hdr;
3782 /* Fill in the sh_link and sh_info fields while we're at it. */
3784 /* sh_link of a reloc section is the section index of the symbol
3785 table. sh_info is the section index of the section to which
3786 the relocation entries apply. */
3787 if (d->rel.idx != 0)
3789 d->rel.hdr->sh_link = elf_onesymtab (abfd);
3790 d->rel.hdr->sh_info = d->this_idx;
3791 d->rel.hdr->sh_flags |= SHF_INFO_LINK;
3793 if (d->rela.idx != 0)
3795 d->rela.hdr->sh_link = elf_onesymtab (abfd);
3796 d->rela.hdr->sh_info = d->this_idx;
3797 d->rela.hdr->sh_flags |= SHF_INFO_LINK;
3800 /* We need to set up sh_link for SHF_LINK_ORDER. */
3801 if ((d->this_hdr.sh_flags & SHF_LINK_ORDER) != 0)
3803 s = elf_linked_to_section (sec);
3806 /* elf_linked_to_section points to the input section. */
3807 if (link_info != NULL)
3809 /* Check discarded linkonce section. */
3810 if (discarded_section (s))
3814 /* xgettext:c-format */
3815 (_("%B: sh_link of section `%A' points to"
3816 " discarded section `%A' of `%B'"),
3817 abfd, d->this_hdr.bfd_section,
3819 /* Point to the kept section if it has the same
3820 size as the discarded one. */
3821 kept = _bfd_elf_check_kept_section (s, link_info);
3824 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
3830 s = s->output_section;
3831 BFD_ASSERT (s != NULL);
3835 /* Handle objcopy. */
3836 if (s->output_section == NULL)
3839 /* xgettext:c-format */
3840 (_("%B: sh_link of section `%A' points to"
3841 " removed section `%A' of `%B'"),
3842 abfd, d->this_hdr.bfd_section, s, s->owner);
3843 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
3846 s = s->output_section;
3848 d->this_hdr.sh_link = elf_section_data (s)->this_idx;
3853 The Intel C compiler generates SHT_IA_64_UNWIND with
3854 SHF_LINK_ORDER. But it doesn't set the sh_link or
3855 sh_info fields. Hence we could get the situation
3857 const struct elf_backend_data *bed
3858 = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
3859 if (bed->link_order_error_handler)
3860 bed->link_order_error_handler
3861 /* xgettext:c-format */
3862 (_("%B: warning: sh_link not set for section `%A'"),
3867 switch (d->this_hdr.sh_type)
3871 /* A reloc section which we are treating as a normal BFD
3872 section. sh_link is the section index of the symbol
3873 table. sh_info is the section index of the section to
3874 which the relocation entries apply. We assume that an
3875 allocated reloc section uses the dynamic symbol table.
3876 FIXME: How can we be sure? */
3877 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".dynsym");
3879 d->this_hdr.sh_link = elf_section_data (s)->this_idx;
3881 s = elf_get_reloc_section (sec);
3884 d->this_hdr.sh_info = elf_section_data (s)->this_idx;
3885 d->this_hdr.sh_flags |= SHF_INFO_LINK;
3890 /* We assume that a section named .stab*str is a stabs
3891 string section. We look for a section with the same name
3892 but without the trailing ``str'', and set its sh_link
3893 field to point to this section. */
3894 if (CONST_STRNEQ (sec->name, ".stab")
3895 && strcmp (sec->name + strlen (sec->name) - 3, "str") == 0)
3900 len = strlen (sec->name);
3901 alc = (char *) bfd_malloc (len - 2);
3904 memcpy (alc, sec->name, len - 3);
3905 alc[len - 3] = '\0';
3906 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, alc);
3910 elf_section_data (s)->this_hdr.sh_link = d->this_idx;
3912 /* This is a .stab section. */
3913 if (elf_section_data (s)->this_hdr.sh_entsize == 0)
3914 elf_section_data (s)->this_hdr.sh_entsize
3915 = 4 + 2 * bfd_get_arch_size (abfd) / 8;
3922 case SHT_GNU_verneed:
3923 case SHT_GNU_verdef:
3924 /* sh_link is the section header index of the string table
3925 used for the dynamic entries, or the symbol table, or the
3927 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".dynstr");
3929 d->this_hdr.sh_link = elf_section_data (s)->this_idx;
3932 case SHT_GNU_LIBLIST:
3933 /* sh_link is the section header index of the prelink library
3934 list used for the dynamic entries, or the symbol table, or
3935 the version strings. */
3936 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, (sec->flags & SEC_ALLOC)
3937 ? ".dynstr" : ".gnu.libstr");
3939 d->this_hdr.sh_link = elf_section_data (s)->this_idx;
3944 case SHT_GNU_versym:
3945 /* sh_link is the section header index of the symbol table
3946 this hash table or version table is for. */
3947 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".dynsym");
3949 d->this_hdr.sh_link = elf_section_data (s)->this_idx;
3953 d->this_hdr.sh_link = elf_onesymtab (abfd);
3957 /* Delay setting sh_name to _bfd_elf_write_object_contents so that
3958 _bfd_elf_assign_file_positions_for_non_load can convert DWARF
3959 debug section name from .debug_* to .zdebug_* if needed. */
3965 sym_is_global (bfd *abfd, asymbol *sym)
3967 /* If the backend has a special mapping, use it. */
3968 const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
3969 if (bed->elf_backend_sym_is_global)
3970 return (*bed->elf_backend_sym_is_global) (abfd, sym);
3972 return ((sym->flags & (BSF_GLOBAL | BSF_WEAK | BSF_GNU_UNIQUE)) != 0
3973 || bfd_is_und_section (bfd_get_section (sym))
3974 || bfd_is_com_section (bfd_get_section (sym)));
3977 /* Filter global symbols of ABFD to include in the import library. All
3978 SYMCOUNT symbols of ABFD can be examined from their pointers in
3979 SYMS. Pointers of symbols to keep should be stored contiguously at
3980 the beginning of that array.
3982 Returns the number of symbols to keep. */
3985 _bfd_elf_filter_global_symbols (bfd *abfd, struct bfd_link_info *info,
3986 asymbol **syms, long symcount)
3988 long src_count, dst_count = 0;
3990 for (src_count = 0; src_count < symcount; src_count++)
3992 asymbol *sym = syms[src_count];
3993 char *name = (char *) bfd_asymbol_name (sym);
3994 struct bfd_link_hash_entry *h;
3996 if (!sym_is_global (abfd, sym))
3999 h = bfd_link_hash_lookup (info->hash, name, FALSE, FALSE, FALSE);
4002 if (h->type != bfd_link_hash_defined && h->type != bfd_link_hash_defweak)
4004 if (h->linker_def || h->ldscript_def)
4007 syms[dst_count++] = sym;
4010 syms[dst_count] = NULL;
4015 /* Don't output section symbols for sections that are not going to be
4016 output, that are duplicates or there is no BFD section. */
4019 ignore_section_sym (bfd *abfd, asymbol *sym)
4021 elf_symbol_type *type_ptr;
4023 if ((sym->flags & BSF_SECTION_SYM) == 0)
4026 type_ptr = elf_symbol_from (abfd, sym);
4027 return ((type_ptr != NULL
4028 && type_ptr->internal_elf_sym.st_shndx != 0
4029 && bfd_is_abs_section (sym->section))
4030 || !(sym->section->owner == abfd
4031 || (sym->section->output_section->owner == abfd
4032 && sym->section->output_offset == 0)
4033 || bfd_is_abs_section (sym->section)));
4036 /* Map symbol from it's internal number to the external number, moving
4037 all local symbols to be at the head of the list. */
4040 elf_map_symbols (bfd *abfd, unsigned int *pnum_locals)
4042 unsigned int symcount = bfd_get_symcount (abfd);
4043 asymbol **syms = bfd_get_outsymbols (abfd);
4044 asymbol **sect_syms;
4045 unsigned int num_locals = 0;
4046 unsigned int num_globals = 0;
4047 unsigned int num_locals2 = 0;
4048 unsigned int num_globals2 = 0;
4049 unsigned int max_index = 0;
4055 fprintf (stderr, "elf_map_symbols\n");
4059 for (asect = abfd->sections; asect; asect = asect->next)
4061 if (max_index < asect->index)
4062 max_index = asect->index;
4066 sect_syms = (asymbol **) bfd_zalloc2 (abfd, max_index, sizeof (asymbol *));
4067 if (sect_syms == NULL)
4069 elf_section_syms (abfd) = sect_syms;
4070 elf_num_section_syms (abfd) = max_index;
4072 /* Init sect_syms entries for any section symbols we have already
4073 decided to output. */
4074 for (idx = 0; idx < symcount; idx++)
4076 asymbol *sym = syms[idx];
4078 if ((sym->flags & BSF_SECTION_SYM) != 0
4080 && !ignore_section_sym (abfd, sym)
4081 && !bfd_is_abs_section (sym->section))
4083 asection *sec = sym->section;
4085 if (sec->owner != abfd)
4086 sec = sec->output_section;
4088 sect_syms[sec->index] = syms[idx];
4092 /* Classify all of the symbols. */
4093 for (idx = 0; idx < symcount; idx++)
4095 if (sym_is_global (abfd, syms[idx]))
4097 else if (!ignore_section_sym (abfd, syms[idx]))
4101 /* We will be adding a section symbol for each normal BFD section. Most
4102 sections will already have a section symbol in outsymbols, but
4103 eg. SHT_GROUP sections will not, and we need the section symbol mapped
4104 at least in that case. */
4105 for (asect = abfd->sections; asect; asect = asect->next)
4107 if (sect_syms[asect->index] == NULL)
4109 if (!sym_is_global (abfd, asect->symbol))
4116 /* Now sort the symbols so the local symbols are first. */
4117 new_syms = (asymbol **) bfd_alloc2 (abfd, num_locals + num_globals,
4118 sizeof (asymbol *));
4120 if (new_syms == NULL)
4123 for (idx = 0; idx < symcount; idx++)
4125 asymbol *sym = syms[idx];
4128 if (sym_is_global (abfd, sym))
4129 i = num_locals + num_globals2++;
4130 else if (!ignore_section_sym (abfd, sym))
4135 sym->udata.i = i + 1;
4137 for (asect = abfd->sections; asect; asect = asect->next)
4139 if (sect_syms[asect->index] == NULL)
4141 asymbol *sym = asect->symbol;
4144 sect_syms[asect->index] = sym;
4145 if (!sym_is_global (abfd, sym))
4148 i = num_locals + num_globals2++;
4150 sym->udata.i = i + 1;
4154 bfd_set_symtab (abfd, new_syms, num_locals + num_globals);
4156 *pnum_locals = num_locals;
4160 /* Align to the maximum file alignment that could be required for any
4161 ELF data structure. */
4163 static inline file_ptr
4164 align_file_position (file_ptr off, int align)
4166 return (off + align - 1) & ~(align - 1);
4169 /* Assign a file position to a section, optionally aligning to the
4170 required section alignment. */
4173 _bfd_elf_assign_file_position_for_section (Elf_Internal_Shdr *i_shdrp,
4177 if (align && i_shdrp->sh_addralign > 1)
4178 offset = BFD_ALIGN (offset, i_shdrp->sh_addralign);
4179 i_shdrp->sh_offset = offset;
4180 if (i_shdrp->bfd_section != NULL)
4181 i_shdrp->bfd_section->filepos = offset;
4182 if (i_shdrp->sh_type != SHT_NOBITS)
4183 offset += i_shdrp->sh_size;
4187 /* Compute the file positions we are going to put the sections at, and
4188 otherwise prepare to begin writing out the ELF file. If LINK_INFO
4189 is not NULL, this is being called by the ELF backend linker. */
4192 _bfd_elf_compute_section_file_positions (bfd *abfd,
4193 struct bfd_link_info *link_info)
4195 const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
4196 struct fake_section_arg fsargs;
4198 struct elf_strtab_hash *strtab = NULL;
4199 Elf_Internal_Shdr *shstrtab_hdr;
4200 bfd_boolean need_symtab;
4202 if (abfd->output_has_begun)
4205 /* Do any elf backend specific processing first. */
4206 if (bed->elf_backend_begin_write_processing)
4207 (*bed->elf_backend_begin_write_processing) (abfd, link_info);
4209 if (! prep_headers (abfd))
4212 /* Post process the headers if necessary. */
4213 (*bed->elf_backend_post_process_headers) (abfd, link_info);
4215 fsargs.failed = FALSE;
4216 fsargs.link_info = link_info;
4217 bfd_map_over_sections (abfd, elf_fake_sections, &fsargs);
4221 if (!assign_section_numbers (abfd, link_info))
4224 /* The backend linker builds symbol table information itself. */
4225 need_symtab = (link_info == NULL
4226 && (bfd_get_symcount (abfd) > 0
4227 || ((abfd->flags & (EXEC_P | DYNAMIC | HAS_RELOC))
4231 /* Non-zero if doing a relocatable link. */
4232 int relocatable_p = ! (abfd->flags & (EXEC_P | DYNAMIC));
4234 if (! swap_out_syms (abfd, &strtab, relocatable_p))
4239 if (link_info == NULL)
4241 bfd_map_over_sections (abfd, bfd_elf_set_group_contents, &failed);
4246 shstrtab_hdr = &elf_tdata (abfd)->shstrtab_hdr;
4247 /* sh_name was set in prep_headers. */
4248 shstrtab_hdr->sh_type = SHT_STRTAB;
4249 shstrtab_hdr->sh_flags = bed->elf_strtab_flags;
4250 shstrtab_hdr->sh_addr = 0;
4251 /* sh_size is set in _bfd_elf_assign_file_positions_for_non_load. */
4252 shstrtab_hdr->sh_entsize = 0;
4253 shstrtab_hdr->sh_link = 0;
4254 shstrtab_hdr->sh_info = 0;
4255 /* sh_offset is set in _bfd_elf_assign_file_positions_for_non_load. */
4256 shstrtab_hdr->sh_addralign = 1;
4258 if (!assign_file_positions_except_relocs (abfd, link_info))
4264 Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr;
4266 off = elf_next_file_pos (abfd);
4268 hdr = & elf_symtab_hdr (abfd);
4269 off = _bfd_elf_assign_file_position_for_section (hdr, off, TRUE);
4271 if (elf_symtab_shndx_list (abfd) != NULL)
4273 hdr = & elf_symtab_shndx_list (abfd)->hdr;
4274 if (hdr->sh_size != 0)
4275 off = _bfd_elf_assign_file_position_for_section (hdr, off, TRUE);
4276 /* FIXME: What about other symtab_shndx sections in the list ? */
4279 hdr = &elf_tdata (abfd)->strtab_hdr;
4280 off = _bfd_elf_assign_file_position_for_section (hdr, off, TRUE);
4282 elf_next_file_pos (abfd) = off;
4284 /* Now that we know where the .strtab section goes, write it
4286 if (bfd_seek (abfd, hdr->sh_offset, SEEK_SET) != 0
4287 || ! _bfd_elf_strtab_emit (abfd, strtab))
4289 _bfd_elf_strtab_free (strtab);
4292 abfd->output_has_begun = TRUE;
4297 /* Make an initial estimate of the size of the program header. If we
4298 get the number wrong here, we'll redo section placement. */
4300 static bfd_size_type
4301 get_program_header_size (bfd *abfd, struct bfd_link_info *info)
4305 const struct elf_backend_data *bed;
4307 /* Assume we will need exactly two PT_LOAD segments: one for text
4308 and one for data. */
4311 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".interp");
4312 if (s != NULL && (s->flags & SEC_LOAD) != 0)
4314 /* If we have a loadable interpreter section, we need a
4315 PT_INTERP segment. In this case, assume we also need a
4316 PT_PHDR segment, although that may not be true for all
4321 if (bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".dynamic") != NULL)
4323 /* We need a PT_DYNAMIC segment. */
4327 if (info != NULL && info->relro)
4329 /* We need a PT_GNU_RELRO segment. */
4333 if (elf_eh_frame_hdr (abfd))
4335 /* We need a PT_GNU_EH_FRAME segment. */
4339 if (elf_stack_flags (abfd))
4341 /* We need a PT_GNU_STACK segment. */
4345 for (s = abfd->sections; s != NULL; s = s->next)
4347 if ((s->flags & SEC_LOAD) != 0
4348 && CONST_STRNEQ (s->name, ".note"))
4350 /* We need a PT_NOTE segment. */
4352 /* Try to create just one PT_NOTE segment
4353 for all adjacent loadable .note* sections.
4354 gABI requires that within a PT_NOTE segment
4355 (and also inside of each SHT_NOTE section)
4356 each note is padded to a multiple of 4 size,
4357 so we check whether the sections are correctly
4359 if (s->alignment_power == 2)
4360 while (s->next != NULL
4361 && s->next->alignment_power == 2
4362 && (s->next->flags & SEC_LOAD) != 0
4363 && CONST_STRNEQ (s->next->name, ".note"))
4368 for (s = abfd->sections; s != NULL; s = s->next)
4370 if (s->flags & SEC_THREAD_LOCAL)
4372 /* We need a PT_TLS segment. */
4378 bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
4380 if ((abfd->flags & D_PAGED) != 0)
4382 /* Add a PT_GNU_MBIND segment for each mbind section. */
4383 unsigned int page_align_power = bfd_log2 (bed->commonpagesize);
4384 for (s = abfd->sections; s != NULL; s = s->next)
4385 if (elf_section_flags (s) & SHF_GNU_MBIND)
4387 if (elf_section_data (s)->this_hdr.sh_info
4391 /* xgettext:c-format */
4392 (_("%B: GNU_MBIN section `%A' has invalid sh_info field: %d"),
4393 abfd, s, elf_section_data (s)->this_hdr.sh_info);
4396 /* Align mbind section to page size. */
4397 if (s->alignment_power < page_align_power)
4398 s->alignment_power = page_align_power;
4403 /* Let the backend count up any program headers it might need. */
4404 if (bed->elf_backend_additional_program_headers)
4408 a = (*bed->elf_backend_additional_program_headers) (abfd, info);
4414 return segs * bed->s->sizeof_phdr;
4417 /* Find the segment that contains the output_section of section. */
4420 _bfd_elf_find_segment_containing_section (bfd * abfd, asection * section)
4422 struct elf_segment_map *m;
4423 Elf_Internal_Phdr *p;
4425 for (m = elf_seg_map (abfd), p = elf_tdata (abfd)->phdr;
4431 for (i = m->count - 1; i >= 0; i--)
4432 if (m->sections[i] == section)
4439 /* Create a mapping from a set of sections to a program segment. */
4441 static struct elf_segment_map *
4442 make_mapping (bfd *abfd,
4443 asection **sections,
4448 struct elf_segment_map *m;
4453 amt = sizeof (struct elf_segment_map);
4454 amt += (to - from - 1) * sizeof (asection *);
4455 m = (struct elf_segment_map *) bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
4459 m->p_type = PT_LOAD;
4460 for (i = from, hdrpp = sections + from; i < to; i++, hdrpp++)
4461 m->sections[i - from] = *hdrpp;
4462 m->count = to - from;
4464 if (from == 0 && phdr)
4466 /* Include the headers in the first PT_LOAD segment. */
4467 m->includes_filehdr = 1;
4468 m->includes_phdrs = 1;
4474 /* Create the PT_DYNAMIC segment, which includes DYNSEC. Returns NULL
4477 struct elf_segment_map *
4478 _bfd_elf_make_dynamic_segment (bfd *abfd, asection *dynsec)
4480 struct elf_segment_map *m;
4482 m = (struct elf_segment_map *) bfd_zalloc (abfd,
4483 sizeof (struct elf_segment_map));
4487 m->p_type = PT_DYNAMIC;
4489 m->sections[0] = dynsec;
4494 /* Possibly add or remove segments from the segment map. */
4497 elf_modify_segment_map (bfd *abfd,
4498 struct bfd_link_info *info,
4499 bfd_boolean remove_empty_load)
4501 struct elf_segment_map **m;
4502 const struct elf_backend_data *bed;
4504 /* The placement algorithm assumes that non allocated sections are
4505 not in PT_LOAD segments. We ensure this here by removing such
4506 sections from the segment map. We also remove excluded
4507 sections. Finally, any PT_LOAD segment without sections is
4509 m = &elf_seg_map (abfd);
4512 unsigned int i, new_count;
4514 for (new_count = 0, i = 0; i < (*m)->count; i++)
4516 if (((*m)->sections[i]->flags & SEC_EXCLUDE) == 0
4517 && (((*m)->sections[i]->flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0
4518 || (*m)->p_type != PT_LOAD))
4520 (*m)->sections[new_count] = (*m)->sections[i];
4524 (*m)->count = new_count;
4526 if (remove_empty_load
4527 && (*m)->p_type == PT_LOAD
4529 && !(*m)->includes_phdrs)
4535 bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
4536 if (bed->elf_backend_modify_segment_map != NULL)
4538 if (!(*bed->elf_backend_modify_segment_map) (abfd, info))
4545 /* Set up a mapping from BFD sections to program segments. */
4548 _bfd_elf_map_sections_to_segments (bfd *abfd, struct bfd_link_info *info)
4551 struct elf_segment_map *m;
4552 asection **sections = NULL;
4553 const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
4554 bfd_boolean no_user_phdrs;
4556 no_user_phdrs = elf_seg_map (abfd) == NULL;
4559 info->user_phdrs = !no_user_phdrs;
4561 if (no_user_phdrs && bfd_count_sections (abfd) != 0)
4565 struct elf_segment_map *mfirst;
4566 struct elf_segment_map **pm;
4569 unsigned int phdr_index;
4570 bfd_vma maxpagesize;
4572 bfd_boolean phdr_in_segment = TRUE;
4573 bfd_boolean writable;
4574 bfd_boolean executable;
4576 asection *first_tls = NULL;
4577 asection *first_mbind = NULL;
4578 asection *dynsec, *eh_frame_hdr;
4580 bfd_vma addr_mask, wrap_to = 0;
4581 bfd_boolean linker_created_pt_phdr_segment = FALSE;
4583 /* Select the allocated sections, and sort them. */
4585 sections = (asection **) bfd_malloc2 (bfd_count_sections (abfd),
4586 sizeof (asection *));
4587 if (sections == NULL)
4590 /* Calculate top address, avoiding undefined behaviour of shift
4591 left operator when shift count is equal to size of type
4593 addr_mask = ((bfd_vma) 1 << (bfd_arch_bits_per_address (abfd) - 1)) - 1;
4594 addr_mask = (addr_mask << 1) + 1;
4597 for (s = abfd->sections; s != NULL; s = s->next)
4599 if ((s->flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0)
4603 /* A wrapping section potentially clashes with header. */
4604 if (((s->lma + s->size) & addr_mask) < (s->lma & addr_mask))
4605 wrap_to = (s->lma + s->size) & addr_mask;
4608 BFD_ASSERT (i <= bfd_count_sections (abfd));
4611 qsort (sections, (size_t) count, sizeof (asection *), elf_sort_sections);
4613 /* Build the mapping. */
4618 /* If we have a .interp section, then create a PT_PHDR segment for
4619 the program headers and a PT_INTERP segment for the .interp
4621 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".interp");
4622 if (s != NULL && (s->flags & SEC_LOAD) != 0)
4624 amt = sizeof (struct elf_segment_map);
4625 m = (struct elf_segment_map *) bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
4629 m->p_type = PT_PHDR;
4631 m->p_flags_valid = 1;
4632 m->includes_phdrs = 1;
4633 linker_created_pt_phdr_segment = TRUE;
4637 amt = sizeof (struct elf_segment_map);
4638 m = (struct elf_segment_map *) bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
4642 m->p_type = PT_INTERP;
4650 /* Look through the sections. We put sections in the same program
4651 segment when the start of the second section can be placed within
4652 a few bytes of the end of the first section. */
4656 maxpagesize = bed->maxpagesize;
4657 /* PR 17512: file: c8455299.
4658 Avoid divide-by-zero errors later on.
4659 FIXME: Should we abort if the maxpagesize is zero ? */
4660 if (maxpagesize == 0)
4664 dynsec = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".dynamic");
4666 && (dynsec->flags & SEC_LOAD) == 0)
4669 /* Deal with -Ttext or something similar such that the first section
4670 is not adjacent to the program headers. This is an
4671 approximation, since at this point we don't know exactly how many
4672 program headers we will need. */
4675 bfd_size_type phdr_size = elf_program_header_size (abfd);
4677 if (phdr_size == (bfd_size_type) -1)
4678 phdr_size = get_program_header_size (abfd, info);
4679 phdr_size += bed->s->sizeof_ehdr;
4680 if ((abfd->flags & D_PAGED) == 0
4681 || (sections[0]->lma & addr_mask) < phdr_size
4682 || ((sections[0]->lma & addr_mask) % maxpagesize
4683 < phdr_size % maxpagesize)
4684 || (sections[0]->lma & addr_mask & -maxpagesize) < wrap_to)
4686 /* PR 20815: The ELF standard says that a PT_PHDR segment, if
4687 present, must be included as part of the memory image of the
4688 program. Ie it must be part of a PT_LOAD segment as well.
4689 If we have had to create our own PT_PHDR segment, but it is
4690 not going to be covered by the first PT_LOAD segment, then
4691 force the inclusion if we can... */
4692 if ((abfd->flags & D_PAGED) != 0
4693 && linker_created_pt_phdr_segment)
4694 phdr_in_segment = TRUE;
4696 phdr_in_segment = FALSE;
4700 for (i = 0, hdrpp = sections; i < count; i++, hdrpp++)
4703 bfd_boolean new_segment;
4707 /* See if this section and the last one will fit in the same
4710 if (last_hdr == NULL)
4712 /* If we don't have a segment yet, then we don't need a new
4713 one (we build the last one after this loop). */
4714 new_segment = FALSE;
4716 else if (last_hdr->lma - last_hdr->vma != hdr->lma - hdr->vma)
4718 /* If this section has a different relation between the
4719 virtual address and the load address, then we need a new
4723 else if (hdr->lma < last_hdr->lma + last_size
4724 || last_hdr->lma + last_size < last_hdr->lma)
4726 /* If this section has a load address that makes it overlap
4727 the previous section, then we need a new segment. */
4730 else if ((abfd->flags & D_PAGED) != 0
4731 && (((last_hdr->lma + last_size - 1) & -maxpagesize)
4732 == (hdr->lma & -maxpagesize)))
4734 /* If we are demand paged then we can't map two disk
4735 pages onto the same memory page. */
4736 new_segment = FALSE;
4738 /* In the next test we have to be careful when last_hdr->lma is close
4739 to the end of the address space. If the aligned address wraps
4740 around to the start of the address space, then there are no more
4741 pages left in memory and it is OK to assume that the current
4742 section can be included in the current segment. */
4743 else if ((BFD_ALIGN (last_hdr->lma + last_size, maxpagesize)
4744 + maxpagesize > last_hdr->lma)
4745 && (BFD_ALIGN (last_hdr->lma + last_size, maxpagesize)
4746 + maxpagesize <= hdr->lma))
4748 /* If putting this section in this segment would force us to
4749 skip a page in the segment, then we need a new segment. */
4752 else if ((last_hdr->flags & (SEC_LOAD | SEC_THREAD_LOCAL)) == 0
4753 && (hdr->flags & (SEC_LOAD | SEC_THREAD_LOCAL)) != 0)
4755 /* We don't want to put a loaded section after a
4756 nonloaded (ie. bss style) section in the same segment
4757 as that will force the non-loaded section to be loaded.
4758 Consider .tbss sections as loaded for this purpose. */
4761 else if ((abfd->flags & D_PAGED) == 0)
4763 /* If the file is not demand paged, which means that we
4764 don't require the sections to be correctly aligned in the
4765 file, then there is no other reason for a new segment. */
4766 new_segment = FALSE;
4768 else if (info != NULL
4769 && info->separate_code
4770 && executable != ((hdr->flags & SEC_CODE) != 0))
4775 && (hdr->flags & SEC_READONLY) == 0)
4777 /* We don't want to put a writable section in a read only
4783 /* Otherwise, we can use the same segment. */
4784 new_segment = FALSE;
4787 /* Allow interested parties a chance to override our decision. */
4788 if (last_hdr != NULL
4790 && info->callbacks->override_segment_assignment != NULL)
4792 = info->callbacks->override_segment_assignment (info, abfd, hdr,
4798 if ((hdr->flags & SEC_READONLY) == 0)
4800 if ((hdr->flags & SEC_CODE) != 0)
4803 /* .tbss sections effectively have zero size. */
4804 if ((hdr->flags & (SEC_THREAD_LOCAL | SEC_LOAD))
4805 != SEC_THREAD_LOCAL)
4806 last_size = hdr->size;
4812 /* We need a new program segment. We must create a new program
4813 header holding all the sections from phdr_index until hdr. */
4815 m = make_mapping (abfd, sections, phdr_index, i, phdr_in_segment);
4822 if ((hdr->flags & SEC_READONLY) == 0)
4827 if ((hdr->flags & SEC_CODE) == 0)
4833 /* .tbss sections effectively have zero size. */
4834 if ((hdr->flags & (SEC_THREAD_LOCAL | SEC_LOAD)) != SEC_THREAD_LOCAL)
4835 last_size = hdr->size;
4839 phdr_in_segment = FALSE;
4842 /* Create a final PT_LOAD program segment, but not if it's just
4844 if (last_hdr != NULL
4845 && (i - phdr_index != 1
4846 || ((last_hdr->flags & (SEC_THREAD_LOCAL | SEC_LOAD))
4847 != SEC_THREAD_LOCAL)))
4849 m = make_mapping (abfd, sections, phdr_index, i, phdr_in_segment);
4857 /* If there is a .dynamic section, throw in a PT_DYNAMIC segment. */
4860 m = _bfd_elf_make_dynamic_segment (abfd, dynsec);
4867 /* For each batch of consecutive loadable .note sections,
4868 add a PT_NOTE segment. We don't use bfd_get_section_by_name,
4869 because if we link together nonloadable .note sections and
4870 loadable .note sections, we will generate two .note sections
4871 in the output file. FIXME: Using names for section types is
4873 for (s = abfd->sections; s != NULL; s = s->next)
4875 if ((s->flags & SEC_LOAD) != 0
4876 && CONST_STRNEQ (s->name, ".note"))
4881 amt = sizeof (struct elf_segment_map);
4882 if (s->alignment_power == 2)
4883 for (s2 = s; s2->next != NULL; s2 = s2->next)
4885 if (s2->next->alignment_power == 2
4886 && (s2->next->flags & SEC_LOAD) != 0
4887 && CONST_STRNEQ (s2->next->name, ".note")
4888 && align_power (s2->lma + s2->size, 2)
4894 amt += (count - 1) * sizeof (asection *);
4895 m = (struct elf_segment_map *) bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
4899 m->p_type = PT_NOTE;
4903 m->sections[m->count - count--] = s;
4904 BFD_ASSERT ((s->flags & SEC_THREAD_LOCAL) == 0);
4907 m->sections[m->count - 1] = s;
4908 BFD_ASSERT ((s->flags & SEC_THREAD_LOCAL) == 0);
4912 if (s->flags & SEC_THREAD_LOCAL)
4918 if (first_mbind == NULL
4919 && (elf_section_flags (s) & SHF_GNU_MBIND) != 0)
4923 /* If there are any SHF_TLS output sections, add PT_TLS segment. */
4926 amt = sizeof (struct elf_segment_map);
4927 amt += (tls_count - 1) * sizeof (asection *);
4928 m = (struct elf_segment_map *) bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
4933 m->count = tls_count;
4934 /* Mandated PF_R. */
4936 m->p_flags_valid = 1;
4938 for (i = 0; i < (unsigned int) tls_count; ++i)
4940 if ((s->flags & SEC_THREAD_LOCAL) == 0)
4943 (_("%B: TLS sections are not adjacent:"), abfd);
4946 while (i < (unsigned int) tls_count)
4948 if ((s->flags & SEC_THREAD_LOCAL) != 0)
4950 _bfd_error_handler (_(" TLS: %A"), s);
4954 _bfd_error_handler (_(" non-TLS: %A"), s);
4957 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
4968 if (first_mbind && (abfd->flags & D_PAGED) != 0)
4969 for (s = first_mbind; s != NULL; s = s->next)
4970 if ((elf_section_flags (s) & SHF_GNU_MBIND) != 0
4971 && (elf_section_data (s)->this_hdr.sh_info
4972 <= PT_GNU_MBIND_NUM))
4974 /* Mandated PF_R. */
4975 unsigned long p_flags = PF_R;
4976 if ((s->flags & SEC_READONLY) == 0)
4978 if ((s->flags & SEC_CODE) != 0)
4981 amt = sizeof (struct elf_segment_map) + sizeof (asection *);
4982 m = bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
4986 m->p_type = (PT_GNU_MBIND_LO
4987 + elf_section_data (s)->this_hdr.sh_info);
4989 m->p_flags_valid = 1;
4991 m->p_flags = p_flags;
4997 /* If there is a .eh_frame_hdr section, throw in a PT_GNU_EH_FRAME
4999 eh_frame_hdr = elf_eh_frame_hdr (abfd);
5000 if (eh_frame_hdr != NULL
5001 && (eh_frame_hdr->output_section->flags & SEC_LOAD) != 0)
5003 amt = sizeof (struct elf_segment_map);
5004 m = (struct elf_segment_map *) bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
5008 m->p_type = PT_GNU_EH_FRAME;
5010 m->sections[0] = eh_frame_hdr->output_section;
5016 if (elf_stack_flags (abfd))
5018 amt = sizeof (struct elf_segment_map);
5019 m = (struct elf_segment_map *) bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
5023 m->p_type = PT_GNU_STACK;
5024 m->p_flags = elf_stack_flags (abfd);
5025 m->p_align = bed->stack_align;
5026 m->p_flags_valid = 1;
5027 m->p_align_valid = m->p_align != 0;
5028 if (info->stacksize > 0)
5030 m->p_size = info->stacksize;
5031 m->p_size_valid = 1;
5038 if (info != NULL && info->relro)
5040 for (m = mfirst; m != NULL; m = m->next)
5042 if (m->p_type == PT_LOAD
5044 && m->sections[0]->vma >= info->relro_start
5045 && m->sections[0]->vma < info->relro_end)
5048 while (--i != (unsigned) -1)
5049 if ((m->sections[i]->flags & (SEC_LOAD | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS))
5050 == (SEC_LOAD | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS))
5053 if (i != (unsigned) -1)
5058 /* Make a PT_GNU_RELRO segment only when it isn't empty. */
5061 amt = sizeof (struct elf_segment_map);
5062 m = (struct elf_segment_map *) bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
5066 m->p_type = PT_GNU_RELRO;
5073 elf_seg_map (abfd) = mfirst;
5076 if (!elf_modify_segment_map (abfd, info, no_user_phdrs))
5079 for (count = 0, m = elf_seg_map (abfd); m != NULL; m = m->next)
5081 elf_program_header_size (abfd) = count * bed->s->sizeof_phdr;
5086 if (sections != NULL)
5091 /* Sort sections by address. */
5094 elf_sort_sections (const void *arg1, const void *arg2)
5096 const asection *sec1 = *(const asection **) arg1;
5097 const asection *sec2 = *(const asection **) arg2;
5098 bfd_size_type size1, size2;
5100 /* Sort by LMA first, since this is the address used to
5101 place the section into a segment. */
5102 if (sec1->lma < sec2->lma)
5104 else if (sec1->lma > sec2->lma)
5107 /* Then sort by VMA. Normally the LMA and the VMA will be
5108 the same, and this will do nothing. */
5109 if (sec1->vma < sec2->vma)
5111 else if (sec1->vma > sec2->vma)
5114 /* Put !SEC_LOAD sections after SEC_LOAD ones. */
5116 #define TOEND(x) (((x)->flags & (SEC_LOAD | SEC_THREAD_LOCAL)) == 0)
5122 /* If the indicies are the same, do not return 0
5123 here, but continue to try the next comparison. */
5124 if (sec1->target_index - sec2->target_index != 0)
5125 return sec1->target_index - sec2->target_index;
5130 else if (TOEND (sec2))
5135 /* Sort by size, to put zero sized sections
5136 before others at the same address. */
5138 size1 = (sec1->flags & SEC_LOAD) ? sec1->size : 0;
5139 size2 = (sec2->flags & SEC_LOAD) ? sec2->size : 0;
5146 return sec1->target_index - sec2->target_index;
5149 /* Ian Lance Taylor writes:
5151 We shouldn't be using % with a negative signed number. That's just
5152 not good. We have to make sure either that the number is not
5153 negative, or that the number has an unsigned type. When the types
5154 are all the same size they wind up as unsigned. When file_ptr is a
5155 larger signed type, the arithmetic winds up as signed long long,
5158 What we're trying to say here is something like ``increase OFF by
5159 the least amount that will cause it to be equal to the VMA modulo
5161 /* In other words, something like:
5163 vma_offset = m->sections[0]->vma % bed->maxpagesize;
5164 off_offset = off % bed->maxpagesize;
5165 if (vma_offset < off_offset)
5166 adjustment = vma_offset + bed->maxpagesize - off_offset;
5168 adjustment = vma_offset - off_offset;
5170 which can be collapsed into the expression below. */
5173 vma_page_aligned_bias (bfd_vma vma, ufile_ptr off, bfd_vma maxpagesize)
5175 /* PR binutils/16199: Handle an alignment of zero. */
5176 if (maxpagesize == 0)
5178 return ((vma - off) % maxpagesize);
5182 print_segment_map (const struct elf_segment_map *m)
5185 const char *pt = get_segment_type (m->p_type);
5190 if (m->p_type >= PT_LOPROC && m->p_type <= PT_HIPROC)
5191 sprintf (buf, "LOPROC+%7.7x",
5192 (unsigned int) (m->p_type - PT_LOPROC));
5193 else if (m->p_type >= PT_LOOS && m->p_type <= PT_HIOS)
5194 sprintf (buf, "LOOS+%7.7x",
5195 (unsigned int) (m->p_type - PT_LOOS));
5197 snprintf (buf, sizeof (buf), "%8.8x",
5198 (unsigned int) m->p_type);
5202 fprintf (stderr, "%s:", pt);
5203 for (j = 0; j < m->count; j++)
5204 fprintf (stderr, " %s", m->sections [j]->name);
5210 write_zeros (bfd *abfd, file_ptr pos, bfd_size_type len)
5215 if (bfd_seek (abfd, pos, SEEK_SET) != 0)
5217 buf = bfd_zmalloc (len);
5220 ret = bfd_bwrite (buf, len, abfd) == len;
5225 /* Assign file positions to the sections based on the mapping from
5226 sections to segments. This function also sets up some fields in
5230 assign_file_positions_for_load_sections (bfd *abfd,
5231 struct bfd_link_info *link_info)
5233 const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
5234 struct elf_segment_map *m;
5235 Elf_Internal_Phdr *phdrs;
5236 Elf_Internal_Phdr *p;
5238 bfd_size_type maxpagesize;
5239 unsigned int pt_load_count = 0;
5242 bfd_vma header_pad = 0;
5244 if (link_info == NULL
5245 && !_bfd_elf_map_sections_to_segments (abfd, link_info))
5249 for (m = elf_seg_map (abfd); m != NULL; m = m->next)
5253 header_pad = m->header_size;
5258 elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_phoff = bed->s->sizeof_ehdr;
5259 elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_phentsize = bed->s->sizeof_phdr;
5263 /* PR binutils/12467. */
5264 elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_phoff = 0;
5265 elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_phentsize = 0;
5268 elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_phnum = alloc;
5270 if (elf_program_header_size (abfd) == (bfd_size_type) -1)
5271 elf_program_header_size (abfd) = alloc * bed->s->sizeof_phdr;
5273 BFD_ASSERT (elf_program_header_size (abfd)
5274 >= alloc * bed->s->sizeof_phdr);
5278 elf_next_file_pos (abfd) = bed->s->sizeof_ehdr;
5282 /* We're writing the size in elf_program_header_size (abfd),
5283 see assign_file_positions_except_relocs, so make sure we have
5284 that amount allocated, with trailing space cleared.
5285 The variable alloc contains the computed need, while
5286 elf_program_header_size (abfd) contains the size used for the
5288 See ld/emultempl/elf-generic.em:gld${EMULATION_NAME}_map_segments
5289 where the layout is forced to according to a larger size in the
5290 last iterations for the testcase ld-elf/header. */
5291 BFD_ASSERT (elf_program_header_size (abfd) % bed->s->sizeof_phdr
5293 phdrs = (Elf_Internal_Phdr *)
5295 (elf_program_header_size (abfd) / bed->s->sizeof_phdr),
5296 sizeof (Elf_Internal_Phdr));
5297 elf_tdata (abfd)->phdr = phdrs;
5302 if ((abfd->flags & D_PAGED) != 0)
5303 maxpagesize = bed->maxpagesize;
5305 off = bed->s->sizeof_ehdr;
5306 off += alloc * bed->s->sizeof_phdr;
5307 if (header_pad < (bfd_vma) off)
5313 for (m = elf_seg_map (abfd), p = phdrs, j = 0;
5315 m = m->next, p++, j++)
5319 bfd_boolean no_contents;
5321 /* If elf_segment_map is not from map_sections_to_segments, the
5322 sections may not be correctly ordered. NOTE: sorting should
5323 not be done to the PT_NOTE section of a corefile, which may
5324 contain several pseudo-sections artificially created by bfd.
5325 Sorting these pseudo-sections breaks things badly. */
5327 && !(elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_type == ET_CORE
5328 && m->p_type == PT_NOTE))
5329 qsort (m->sections, (size_t) m->count, sizeof (asection *),
5332 /* An ELF segment (described by Elf_Internal_Phdr) may contain a
5333 number of sections with contents contributing to both p_filesz
5334 and p_memsz, followed by a number of sections with no contents
5335 that just contribute to p_memsz. In this loop, OFF tracks next
5336 available file offset for PT_LOAD and PT_NOTE segments. */
5337 p->p_type = m->p_type;
5338 p->p_flags = m->p_flags;
5343 p->p_vaddr = m->sections[0]->vma - m->p_vaddr_offset;
5345 if (m->p_paddr_valid)
5346 p->p_paddr = m->p_paddr;
5347 else if (m->count == 0)
5350 p->p_paddr = m->sections[0]->lma - m->p_vaddr_offset;
5352 if (p->p_type == PT_LOAD
5353 && (abfd->flags & D_PAGED) != 0)
5355 /* p_align in demand paged PT_LOAD segments effectively stores
5356 the maximum page size. When copying an executable with
5357 objcopy, we set m->p_align from the input file. Use this
5358 value for maxpagesize rather than bed->maxpagesize, which
5359 may be different. Note that we use maxpagesize for PT_TLS
5360 segment alignment later in this function, so we are relying
5361 on at least one PT_LOAD segment appearing before a PT_TLS
5363 if (m->p_align_valid)
5364 maxpagesize = m->p_align;
5366 p->p_align = maxpagesize;
5369 else if (m->p_align_valid)
5370 p->p_align = m->p_align;
5371 else if (m->count == 0)
5372 p->p_align = 1 << bed->s->log_file_align;
5376 no_contents = FALSE;
5378 if (p->p_type == PT_LOAD
5381 bfd_size_type align;
5382 unsigned int align_power = 0;
5384 if (m->p_align_valid)
5388 for (i = 0, secpp = m->sections; i < m->count; i++, secpp++)
5390 unsigned int secalign;
5392 secalign = bfd_get_section_alignment (abfd, *secpp);
5393 if (secalign > align_power)
5394 align_power = secalign;
5396 align = (bfd_size_type) 1 << align_power;
5397 if (align < maxpagesize)
5398 align = maxpagesize;
5401 for (i = 0; i < m->count; i++)
5402 if ((m->sections[i]->flags & (SEC_LOAD | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS)) == 0)
5403 /* If we aren't making room for this section, then
5404 it must be SHT_NOBITS regardless of what we've
5405 set via struct bfd_elf_special_section. */
5406 elf_section_type (m->sections[i]) = SHT_NOBITS;
5408 /* Find out whether this segment contains any loadable
5411 for (i = 0; i < m->count; i++)
5412 if (elf_section_type (m->sections[i]) != SHT_NOBITS)
5414 no_contents = FALSE;
5418 off_adjust = vma_page_aligned_bias (p->p_vaddr, off, align);
5420 /* Broken hardware and/or kernel require that files do not
5421 map the same page with different permissions on some hppa
5423 if (pt_load_count > 1
5424 && bed->no_page_alias
5425 && (off & (maxpagesize - 1)) != 0
5426 && (off & -maxpagesize) == ((off + off_adjust) & -maxpagesize))
5427 off_adjust += maxpagesize;
5431 /* We shouldn't need to align the segment on disk since
5432 the segment doesn't need file space, but the gABI
5433 arguably requires the alignment and glibc ld.so
5434 checks it. So to comply with the alignment
5435 requirement but not waste file space, we adjust
5436 p_offset for just this segment. (OFF_ADJUST is
5437 subtracted from OFF later.) This may put p_offset
5438 past the end of file, but that shouldn't matter. */
5443 /* Make sure the .dynamic section is the first section in the
5444 PT_DYNAMIC segment. */
5445 else if (p->p_type == PT_DYNAMIC
5447 && strcmp (m->sections[0]->name, ".dynamic") != 0)
5450 (_("%B: The first section in the PT_DYNAMIC segment"
5451 " is not the .dynamic section"),
5453 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
5456 /* Set the note section type to SHT_NOTE. */
5457 else if (p->p_type == PT_NOTE)
5458 for (i = 0; i < m->count; i++)
5459 elf_section_type (m->sections[i]) = SHT_NOTE;
5465 if (m->includes_filehdr)
5467 if (!m->p_flags_valid)
5469 p->p_filesz = bed->s->sizeof_ehdr;
5470 p->p_memsz = bed->s->sizeof_ehdr;
5473 if (p->p_vaddr < (bfd_vma) off
5474 || (!m->p_paddr_valid
5475 && p->p_paddr < (bfd_vma) off))
5478 (_("%B: Not enough room for program headers,"
5479 " try linking with -N"),
5481 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
5486 if (!m->p_paddr_valid)
5491 if (m->includes_phdrs)
5493 if (!m->p_flags_valid)
5496 if (!m->includes_filehdr)
5498 p->p_offset = bed->s->sizeof_ehdr;
5502 p->p_vaddr -= off - p->p_offset;
5503 if (!m->p_paddr_valid)
5504 p->p_paddr -= off - p->p_offset;
5508 p->p_filesz += alloc * bed->s->sizeof_phdr;
5509 p->p_memsz += alloc * bed->s->sizeof_phdr;
5512 p->p_filesz += header_pad;
5513 p->p_memsz += header_pad;
5517 if (p->p_type == PT_LOAD
5518 || (p->p_type == PT_NOTE && bfd_get_format (abfd) == bfd_core))
5520 if (!m->includes_filehdr && !m->includes_phdrs)
5526 adjust = off - (p->p_offset + p->p_filesz);
5528 p->p_filesz += adjust;
5529 p->p_memsz += adjust;
5533 /* Set up p_filesz, p_memsz, p_align and p_flags from the section
5534 maps. Set filepos for sections in PT_LOAD segments, and in
5535 core files, for sections in PT_NOTE segments.
5536 assign_file_positions_for_non_load_sections will set filepos
5537 for other sections and update p_filesz for other segments. */
5538 for (i = 0, secpp = m->sections; i < m->count; i++, secpp++)
5541 bfd_size_type align;
5542 Elf_Internal_Shdr *this_hdr;
5545 this_hdr = &elf_section_data (sec)->this_hdr;
5546 align = (bfd_size_type) 1 << bfd_get_section_alignment (abfd, sec);
5548 if ((p->p_type == PT_LOAD
5549 || p->p_type == PT_TLS)
5550 && (this_hdr->sh_type != SHT_NOBITS
5551 || ((this_hdr->sh_flags & SHF_ALLOC) != 0
5552 && ((this_hdr->sh_flags & SHF_TLS) == 0
5553 || p->p_type == PT_TLS))))
5555 bfd_vma p_start = p->p_paddr;
5556 bfd_vma p_end = p_start + p->p_memsz;
5557 bfd_vma s_start = sec->lma;
5558 bfd_vma adjust = s_start - p_end;
5562 || p_end < p_start))
5565 /* xgettext:c-format */
5566 (_("%B: section %A lma %#Lx adjusted to %#Lx"),
5567 abfd, sec, s_start, p_end);
5571 p->p_memsz += adjust;
5573 if (this_hdr->sh_type != SHT_NOBITS)
5575 if (p->p_filesz + adjust < p->p_memsz)
5577 /* We have a PROGBITS section following NOBITS ones.
5578 Allocate file space for the NOBITS section(s) and
5580 adjust = p->p_memsz - p->p_filesz;
5581 if (!write_zeros (abfd, off, adjust))
5585 p->p_filesz += adjust;
5589 if (p->p_type == PT_NOTE && bfd_get_format (abfd) == bfd_core)
5591 /* The section at i == 0 is the one that actually contains
5595 this_hdr->sh_offset = sec->filepos = off;
5596 off += this_hdr->sh_size;
5597 p->p_filesz = this_hdr->sh_size;
5603 /* The rest are fake sections that shouldn't be written. */
5612 if (p->p_type == PT_LOAD)
5614 this_hdr->sh_offset = sec->filepos = off;
5615 if (this_hdr->sh_type != SHT_NOBITS)
5616 off += this_hdr->sh_size;
5618 else if (this_hdr->sh_type == SHT_NOBITS
5619 && (this_hdr->sh_flags & SHF_TLS) != 0
5620 && this_hdr->sh_offset == 0)
5622 /* This is a .tbss section that didn't get a PT_LOAD.
5623 (See _bfd_elf_map_sections_to_segments "Create a
5624 final PT_LOAD".) Set sh_offset to the value it
5625 would have if we had created a zero p_filesz and
5626 p_memsz PT_LOAD header for the section. This
5627 also makes the PT_TLS header have the same
5629 bfd_vma adjust = vma_page_aligned_bias (this_hdr->sh_addr,
5631 this_hdr->sh_offset = sec->filepos = off + adjust;
5634 if (this_hdr->sh_type != SHT_NOBITS)
5636 p->p_filesz += this_hdr->sh_size;
5637 /* A load section without SHF_ALLOC is something like
5638 a note section in a PT_NOTE segment. These take
5639 file space but are not loaded into memory. */
5640 if ((this_hdr->sh_flags & SHF_ALLOC) != 0)
5641 p->p_memsz += this_hdr->sh_size;
5643 else if ((this_hdr->sh_flags & SHF_ALLOC) != 0)
5645 if (p->p_type == PT_TLS)
5646 p->p_memsz += this_hdr->sh_size;
5648 /* .tbss is special. It doesn't contribute to p_memsz of
5650 else if ((this_hdr->sh_flags & SHF_TLS) == 0)
5651 p->p_memsz += this_hdr->sh_size;
5654 if (align > p->p_align
5655 && !m->p_align_valid
5656 && (p->p_type != PT_LOAD
5657 || (abfd->flags & D_PAGED) == 0))
5661 if (!m->p_flags_valid)
5664 if ((this_hdr->sh_flags & SHF_EXECINSTR) != 0)
5666 if ((this_hdr->sh_flags & SHF_WRITE) != 0)
5673 /* Check that all sections are in a PT_LOAD segment.
5674 Don't check funky gdb generated core files. */
5675 if (p->p_type == PT_LOAD && bfd_get_format (abfd) != bfd_core)
5677 bfd_boolean check_vma = TRUE;
5679 for (i = 1; i < m->count; i++)
5680 if (m->sections[i]->vma == m->sections[i - 1]->vma
5681 && ELF_SECTION_SIZE (&(elf_section_data (m->sections[i])
5682 ->this_hdr), p) != 0
5683 && ELF_SECTION_SIZE (&(elf_section_data (m->sections[i - 1])
5684 ->this_hdr), p) != 0)
5686 /* Looks like we have overlays packed into the segment. */
5691 for (i = 0; i < m->count; i++)
5693 Elf_Internal_Shdr *this_hdr;
5696 sec = m->sections[i];
5697 this_hdr = &(elf_section_data(sec)->this_hdr);
5698 if (!ELF_SECTION_IN_SEGMENT_1 (this_hdr, p, check_vma, 0)
5699 && !ELF_TBSS_SPECIAL (this_hdr, p))
5702 /* xgettext:c-format */
5703 (_("%B: section `%A' can't be allocated in segment %d"),
5705 print_segment_map (m);
5711 elf_next_file_pos (abfd) = off;
5715 /* Assign file positions for the other sections. */
5718 assign_file_positions_for_non_load_sections (bfd *abfd,
5719 struct bfd_link_info *link_info)
5721 const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
5722 Elf_Internal_Shdr **i_shdrpp;
5723 Elf_Internal_Shdr **hdrpp, **end_hdrpp;
5724 Elf_Internal_Phdr *phdrs;
5725 Elf_Internal_Phdr *p;
5726 struct elf_segment_map *m;
5727 struct elf_segment_map *hdrs_segment;
5728 bfd_vma filehdr_vaddr, filehdr_paddr;
5729 bfd_vma phdrs_vaddr, phdrs_paddr;
5733 i_shdrpp = elf_elfsections (abfd);
5734 end_hdrpp = i_shdrpp + elf_numsections (abfd);
5735 off = elf_next_file_pos (abfd);
5736 for (hdrpp = i_shdrpp + 1; hdrpp < end_hdrpp; hdrpp++)
5738 Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr;
5741 if (hdr->bfd_section != NULL
5742 && (hdr->bfd_section->filepos != 0
5743 || (hdr->sh_type == SHT_NOBITS
5744 && hdr->contents == NULL)))
5745 BFD_ASSERT (hdr->sh_offset == hdr->bfd_section->filepos);
5746 else if ((hdr->sh_flags & SHF_ALLOC) != 0)
5748 if (hdr->sh_size != 0)
5750 /* xgettext:c-format */
5751 (_("%B: warning: allocated section `%s' not in segment"),
5753 (hdr->bfd_section == NULL
5755 : hdr->bfd_section->name));
5756 /* We don't need to page align empty sections. */
5757 if ((abfd->flags & D_PAGED) != 0 && hdr->sh_size != 0)
5758 off += vma_page_aligned_bias (hdr->sh_addr, off,
5761 off += vma_page_aligned_bias (hdr->sh_addr, off,
5763 off = _bfd_elf_assign_file_position_for_section (hdr, off,
5766 else if (((hdr->sh_type == SHT_REL || hdr->sh_type == SHT_RELA)
5767 && hdr->bfd_section == NULL)
5768 || (hdr->bfd_section != NULL
5769 && (hdr->bfd_section->flags & SEC_ELF_COMPRESS))
5770 /* Compress DWARF debug sections. */
5771 || hdr == i_shdrpp[elf_onesymtab (abfd)]
5772 || (elf_symtab_shndx_list (abfd) != NULL
5773 && hdr == i_shdrpp[elf_symtab_shndx_list (abfd)->ndx])
5774 || hdr == i_shdrpp[elf_strtab_sec (abfd)]
5775 || hdr == i_shdrpp[elf_shstrtab_sec (abfd)])
5776 hdr->sh_offset = -1;
5778 off = _bfd_elf_assign_file_position_for_section (hdr, off, TRUE);
5781 /* Now that we have set the section file positions, we can set up
5782 the file positions for the non PT_LOAD segments. */
5786 phdrs_vaddr = bed->maxpagesize + bed->s->sizeof_ehdr;
5788 hdrs_segment = NULL;
5789 phdrs = elf_tdata (abfd)->phdr;
5790 for (m = elf_seg_map (abfd), p = phdrs; m != NULL; m = m->next, p++)
5793 if (p->p_type != PT_LOAD)
5796 if (m->includes_filehdr)
5798 filehdr_vaddr = p->p_vaddr;
5799 filehdr_paddr = p->p_paddr;
5801 if (m->includes_phdrs)
5803 phdrs_vaddr = p->p_vaddr;
5804 phdrs_paddr = p->p_paddr;
5805 if (m->includes_filehdr)
5808 phdrs_vaddr += bed->s->sizeof_ehdr;
5809 phdrs_paddr += bed->s->sizeof_ehdr;
5814 if (hdrs_segment != NULL && link_info != NULL)
5816 /* There is a segment that contains both the file headers and the
5817 program headers, so provide a symbol __ehdr_start pointing there.
5818 A program can use this to examine itself robustly. */
5820 struct elf_link_hash_entry *hash
5821 = elf_link_hash_lookup (elf_hash_table (link_info), "__ehdr_start",
5822 FALSE, FALSE, TRUE);
5823 /* If the symbol was referenced and not defined, define it. */
5825 && (hash->root.type == bfd_link_hash_new
5826 || hash->root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefined
5827 || hash->root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefweak
5828 || hash->root.type == bfd_link_hash_common))
5831 if (hdrs_segment->count != 0)
5832 /* The segment contains sections, so use the first one. */
5833 s = hdrs_segment->sections[0];
5835 /* Use the first (i.e. lowest-addressed) section in any segment. */
5836 for (m = elf_seg_map (abfd); m != NULL; m = m->next)
5845 hash->root.u.def.value = filehdr_vaddr - s->vma;
5846 hash->root.u.def.section = s;
5850 hash->root.u.def.value = filehdr_vaddr;
5851 hash->root.u.def.section = bfd_abs_section_ptr;
5854 hash->root.type = bfd_link_hash_defined;
5855 hash->def_regular = 1;
5860 for (m = elf_seg_map (abfd), p = phdrs; m != NULL; m = m->next, p++)
5862 if (p->p_type == PT_GNU_RELRO)
5864 const Elf_Internal_Phdr *lp;
5865 struct elf_segment_map *lm;
5867 if (link_info != NULL)
5869 /* During linking the range of the RELRO segment is passed
5871 for (lm = elf_seg_map (abfd), lp = phdrs;
5873 lm = lm->next, lp++)
5875 if (lp->p_type == PT_LOAD
5876 && lp->p_vaddr < link_info->relro_end
5878 && lm->sections[0]->vma >= link_info->relro_start)
5882 BFD_ASSERT (lm != NULL);
5886 /* Otherwise we are copying an executable or shared
5887 library, but we need to use the same linker logic. */
5888 for (lp = phdrs; lp < phdrs + count; ++lp)
5890 if (lp->p_type == PT_LOAD
5891 && lp->p_paddr == p->p_paddr)
5896 if (lp < phdrs + count)
5898 p->p_vaddr = lp->p_vaddr;
5899 p->p_paddr = lp->p_paddr;
5900 p->p_offset = lp->p_offset;
5901 if (link_info != NULL)
5902 p->p_filesz = link_info->relro_end - lp->p_vaddr;
5903 else if (m->p_size_valid)
5904 p->p_filesz = m->p_size;
5907 p->p_memsz = p->p_filesz;
5908 /* Preserve the alignment and flags if they are valid. The
5909 gold linker generates RW/4 for the PT_GNU_RELRO section.
5910 It is better for objcopy/strip to honor these attributes
5911 otherwise gdb will choke when using separate debug files.
5913 if (!m->p_align_valid)
5915 if (!m->p_flags_valid)
5920 memset (p, 0, sizeof *p);
5921 p->p_type = PT_NULL;
5924 else if (p->p_type == PT_GNU_STACK)
5926 if (m->p_size_valid)
5927 p->p_memsz = m->p_size;
5929 else if (m->count != 0)
5933 if (p->p_type != PT_LOAD
5934 && (p->p_type != PT_NOTE
5935 || bfd_get_format (abfd) != bfd_core))
5937 /* A user specified segment layout may include a PHDR
5938 segment that overlaps with a LOAD segment... */
5939 if (p->p_type == PT_PHDR)
5945 if (m->includes_filehdr || m->includes_phdrs)
5947 /* PR 17512: file: 2195325e. */
5949 (_("%B: error: non-load segment %d includes file header "
5950 "and/or program header"),
5951 abfd, (int) (p - phdrs));
5956 p->p_offset = m->sections[0]->filepos;
5957 for (i = m->count; i-- != 0;)
5959 asection *sect = m->sections[i];
5960 Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr = &elf_section_data (sect)->this_hdr;
5961 if (hdr->sh_type != SHT_NOBITS)
5963 p->p_filesz = (sect->filepos - m->sections[0]->filepos
5970 else if (m->includes_filehdr)
5972 p->p_vaddr = filehdr_vaddr;
5973 if (! m->p_paddr_valid)
5974 p->p_paddr = filehdr_paddr;
5976 else if (m->includes_phdrs)
5978 p->p_vaddr = phdrs_vaddr;
5979 if (! m->p_paddr_valid)
5980 p->p_paddr = phdrs_paddr;
5984 elf_next_file_pos (abfd) = off;
5989 static elf_section_list *
5990 find_section_in_list (unsigned int i, elf_section_list * list)
5992 for (;list != NULL; list = list->next)
5998 /* Work out the file positions of all the sections. This is called by
5999 _bfd_elf_compute_section_file_positions. All the section sizes and
6000 VMAs must be known before this is called.
6002 Reloc sections come in two flavours: Those processed specially as
6003 "side-channel" data attached to a section to which they apply, and
6004 those that bfd doesn't process as relocations. The latter sort are
6005 stored in a normal bfd section by bfd_section_from_shdr. We don't
6006 consider the former sort here, unless they form part of the loadable
6007 image. Reloc sections not assigned here will be handled later by
6008 assign_file_positions_for_relocs.
6010 We also don't set the positions of the .symtab and .strtab here. */
6013 assign_file_positions_except_relocs (bfd *abfd,
6014 struct bfd_link_info *link_info)
6016 struct elf_obj_tdata *tdata = elf_tdata (abfd);
6017 Elf_Internal_Ehdr *i_ehdrp = elf_elfheader (abfd);
6018 const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
6020 if ((abfd->flags & (EXEC_P | DYNAMIC)) == 0
6021 && bfd_get_format (abfd) != bfd_core)
6023 Elf_Internal_Shdr ** const i_shdrpp = elf_elfsections (abfd);
6024 unsigned int num_sec = elf_numsections (abfd);
6025 Elf_Internal_Shdr **hdrpp;
6029 /* Start after the ELF header. */
6030 off = i_ehdrp->e_ehsize;
6032 /* We are not creating an executable, which means that we are
6033 not creating a program header, and that the actual order of
6034 the sections in the file is unimportant. */
6035 for (i = 1, hdrpp = i_shdrpp + 1; i < num_sec; i++, hdrpp++)
6037 Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr;
6040 if (((hdr->sh_type == SHT_REL || hdr->sh_type == SHT_RELA)
6041 && hdr->bfd_section == NULL)
6042 || (hdr->bfd_section != NULL
6043 && (hdr->bfd_section->flags & SEC_ELF_COMPRESS))
6044 /* Compress DWARF debug sections. */
6045 || i == elf_onesymtab (abfd)
6046 || (elf_symtab_shndx_list (abfd) != NULL
6047 && hdr == i_shdrpp[elf_symtab_shndx_list (abfd)->ndx])
6048 || i == elf_strtab_sec (abfd)
6049 || i == elf_shstrtab_sec (abfd))
6051 hdr->sh_offset = -1;
6054 off = _bfd_elf_assign_file_position_for_section (hdr, off, TRUE);
6057 elf_next_file_pos (abfd) = off;
6063 /* Assign file positions for the loaded sections based on the
6064 assignment of sections to segments. */
6065 if (!assign_file_positions_for_load_sections (abfd, link_info))
6068 /* And for non-load sections. */
6069 if (!assign_file_positions_for_non_load_sections (abfd, link_info))
6072 if (bed->elf_backend_modify_program_headers != NULL)
6074 if (!(*bed->elf_backend_modify_program_headers) (abfd, link_info))
6078 /* Set e_type in ELF header to ET_EXEC for -pie -Ttext-segment=. */
6079 if (link_info != NULL && bfd_link_pie (link_info))
6081 unsigned int num_segments = elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_phnum;
6082 Elf_Internal_Phdr *segment = elf_tdata (abfd)->phdr;
6083 Elf_Internal_Phdr *end_segment = &segment[num_segments];
6085 /* Find the lowest p_vaddr in PT_LOAD segments. */
6086 bfd_vma p_vaddr = (bfd_vma) -1;
6087 for (; segment < end_segment; segment++)
6088 if (segment->p_type == PT_LOAD && p_vaddr > segment->p_vaddr)
6089 p_vaddr = segment->p_vaddr;
6091 /* Set e_type to ET_EXEC if the lowest p_vaddr in PT_LOAD
6092 segments is non-zero. */
6094 i_ehdrp->e_type = ET_EXEC;
6097 /* Write out the program headers. */
6098 alloc = elf_program_header_size (abfd) / bed->s->sizeof_phdr;
6100 /* Sort the program headers into the ordering required by the ELF standard. */
6104 /* PR ld/20815 - Check that the program header segment, if present, will
6105 be loaded into memory. FIXME: The check below is not sufficient as
6106 really all PT_LOAD segments should be checked before issuing an error
6107 message. Plus the PHDR segment does not have to be the first segment
6108 in the program header table. But this version of the check should
6109 catch all real world use cases.
6111 FIXME: We used to have code here to sort the PT_LOAD segments into
6112 ascending order, as per the ELF spec. But this breaks some programs,
6113 including the Linux kernel. But really either the spec should be
6114 changed or the programs updated. */
6116 && tdata->phdr[0].p_type == PT_PHDR
6117 && ! bed->elf_backend_allow_non_load_phdr (abfd, tdata->phdr, alloc)
6118 && tdata->phdr[1].p_type == PT_LOAD
6119 && (tdata->phdr[1].p_vaddr > tdata->phdr[0].p_vaddr
6120 || (tdata->phdr[1].p_vaddr + tdata->phdr[1].p_memsz)
6121 < (tdata->phdr[0].p_vaddr + tdata->phdr[0].p_memsz)))
6123 /* The fix for this error is usually to edit the linker script being
6124 used and set up the program headers manually. Either that or
6125 leave room for the headers at the start of the SECTIONS. */
6126 _bfd_error_handler (_("\
6127 %B: error: PHDR segment not covered by LOAD segment"),
6132 if (bfd_seek (abfd, (bfd_signed_vma) bed->s->sizeof_ehdr, SEEK_SET) != 0
6133 || bed->s->write_out_phdrs (abfd, tdata->phdr, alloc) != 0)
6141 prep_headers (bfd *abfd)
6143 Elf_Internal_Ehdr *i_ehdrp; /* Elf file header, internal form. */
6144 struct elf_strtab_hash *shstrtab;
6145 const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
6147 i_ehdrp = elf_elfheader (abfd);
6149 shstrtab = _bfd_elf_strtab_init ();
6150 if (shstrtab == NULL)
6153 elf_shstrtab (abfd) = shstrtab;
6155 i_ehdrp->e_ident[EI_MAG0] = ELFMAG0;
6156 i_ehdrp->e_ident[EI_MAG1] = ELFMAG1;
6157 i_ehdrp->e_ident[EI_MAG2] = ELFMAG2;
6158 i_ehdrp->e_ident[EI_MAG3] = ELFMAG3;
6160 i_ehdrp->e_ident[EI_CLASS] = bed->s->elfclass;
6161 i_ehdrp->e_ident[EI_DATA] =
6162 bfd_big_endian (abfd) ? ELFDATA2MSB : ELFDATA2LSB;
6163 i_ehdrp->e_ident[EI_VERSION] = bed->s->ev_current;
6165 if ((abfd->flags & DYNAMIC) != 0)
6166 i_ehdrp->e_type = ET_DYN;
6167 else if ((abfd->flags & EXEC_P) != 0)
6168 i_ehdrp->e_type = ET_EXEC;
6169 else if (bfd_get_format (abfd) == bfd_core)
6170 i_ehdrp->e_type = ET_CORE;
6172 i_ehdrp->e_type = ET_REL;
6174 switch (bfd_get_arch (abfd))
6176 case bfd_arch_unknown:
6177 i_ehdrp->e_machine = EM_NONE;
6180 /* There used to be a long list of cases here, each one setting
6181 e_machine to the same EM_* macro #defined as ELF_MACHINE_CODE
6182 in the corresponding bfd definition. To avoid duplication,
6183 the switch was removed. Machines that need special handling
6184 can generally do it in elf_backend_final_write_processing(),
6185 unless they need the information earlier than the final write.
6186 Such need can generally be supplied by replacing the tests for
6187 e_machine with the conditions used to determine it. */
6189 i_ehdrp->e_machine = bed->elf_machine_code;
6192 i_ehdrp->e_version = bed->s->ev_current;
6193 i_ehdrp->e_ehsize = bed->s->sizeof_ehdr;
6195 /* No program header, for now. */
6196 i_ehdrp->e_phoff = 0;
6197 i_ehdrp->e_phentsize = 0;
6198 i_ehdrp->e_phnum = 0;
6200 /* Each bfd section is section header entry. */
6201 i_ehdrp->e_entry = bfd_get_start_address (abfd);
6202 i_ehdrp->e_shentsize = bed->s->sizeof_shdr;
6204 /* If we're building an executable, we'll need a program header table. */
6205 if (abfd->flags & EXEC_P)
6206 /* It all happens later. */
6210 i_ehdrp->e_phentsize = 0;
6211 i_ehdrp->e_phoff = 0;
6214 elf_tdata (abfd)->symtab_hdr.sh_name =
6215 (unsigned int) _bfd_elf_strtab_add (shstrtab, ".symtab", FALSE);
6216 elf_tdata (abfd)->strtab_hdr.sh_name =
6217 (unsigned int) _bfd_elf_strtab_add (shstrtab, ".strtab", FALSE);
6218 elf_tdata (abfd)->shstrtab_hdr.sh_name =
6219 (unsigned int) _bfd_elf_strtab_add (shstrtab, ".shstrtab", FALSE);
6220 if (elf_tdata (abfd)->symtab_hdr.sh_name == (unsigned int) -1
6221 || elf_tdata (abfd)->strtab_hdr.sh_name == (unsigned int) -1
6222 || elf_tdata (abfd)->shstrtab_hdr.sh_name == (unsigned int) -1)
6228 /* Assign file positions for all the reloc sections which are not part
6229 of the loadable file image, and the file position of section headers. */
6232 _bfd_elf_assign_file_positions_for_non_load (bfd *abfd)
6235 Elf_Internal_Shdr **shdrpp, **end_shdrpp;
6236 Elf_Internal_Shdr *shdrp;
6237 Elf_Internal_Ehdr *i_ehdrp;
6238 const struct elf_backend_data *bed;
6240 off = elf_next_file_pos (abfd);
6242 shdrpp = elf_elfsections (abfd);
6243 end_shdrpp = shdrpp + elf_numsections (abfd);
6244 for (shdrpp++; shdrpp < end_shdrpp; shdrpp++)
6247 if (shdrp->sh_offset == -1)
6249 asection *sec = shdrp->bfd_section;
6250 bfd_boolean is_rel = (shdrp->sh_type == SHT_REL
6251 || shdrp->sh_type == SHT_RELA);
6253 || (sec != NULL && (sec->flags & SEC_ELF_COMPRESS)))
6257 const char *name = sec->name;
6258 struct bfd_elf_section_data *d;
6260 /* Compress DWARF debug sections. */
6261 if (!bfd_compress_section (abfd, sec,
6265 if (sec->compress_status == COMPRESS_SECTION_DONE
6266 && (abfd->flags & BFD_COMPRESS_GABI) == 0)
6268 /* If section is compressed with zlib-gnu, convert
6269 section name from .debug_* to .zdebug_*. */
6271 = convert_debug_to_zdebug (abfd, name);
6272 if (new_name == NULL)
6276 /* Add section name to section name section. */
6277 if (shdrp->sh_name != (unsigned int) -1)
6280 = (unsigned int) _bfd_elf_strtab_add (elf_shstrtab (abfd),
6282 d = elf_section_data (sec);
6284 /* Add reloc section name to section name section. */
6286 && !_bfd_elf_set_reloc_sh_name (abfd,
6291 && !_bfd_elf_set_reloc_sh_name (abfd,
6296 /* Update section size and contents. */
6297 shdrp->sh_size = sec->size;
6298 shdrp->contents = sec->contents;
6299 shdrp->bfd_section->contents = NULL;
6301 off = _bfd_elf_assign_file_position_for_section (shdrp,
6308 /* Place section name section after DWARF debug sections have been
6310 _bfd_elf_strtab_finalize (elf_shstrtab (abfd));
6311 shdrp = &elf_tdata (abfd)->shstrtab_hdr;
6312 shdrp->sh_size = _bfd_elf_strtab_size (elf_shstrtab (abfd));
6313 off = _bfd_elf_assign_file_position_for_section (shdrp, off, TRUE);
6315 /* Place the section headers. */
6316 i_ehdrp = elf_elfheader (abfd);
6317 bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
6318 off = align_file_position (off, 1 << bed->s->log_file_align);
6319 i_ehdrp->e_shoff = off;
6320 off += i_ehdrp->e_shnum * i_ehdrp->e_shentsize;
6321 elf_next_file_pos (abfd) = off;
6327 _bfd_elf_write_object_contents (bfd *abfd)
6329 const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
6330 Elf_Internal_Shdr **i_shdrp;
6332 unsigned int count, num_sec;
6333 struct elf_obj_tdata *t;
6335 if (! abfd->output_has_begun
6336 && ! _bfd_elf_compute_section_file_positions (abfd, NULL))
6339 i_shdrp = elf_elfsections (abfd);
6342 bfd_map_over_sections (abfd, bed->s->write_relocs, &failed);
6346 if (!_bfd_elf_assign_file_positions_for_non_load (abfd))
6349 /* After writing the headers, we need to write the sections too... */
6350 num_sec = elf_numsections (abfd);
6351 for (count = 1; count < num_sec; count++)
6353 i_shdrp[count]->sh_name
6354 = _bfd_elf_strtab_offset (elf_shstrtab (abfd),
6355 i_shdrp[count]->sh_name);
6356 if (bed->elf_backend_section_processing)
6357 if (!(*bed->elf_backend_section_processing) (abfd, i_shdrp[count]))
6359 if (i_shdrp[count]->contents)
6361 bfd_size_type amt = i_shdrp[count]->sh_size;
6363 if (bfd_seek (abfd, i_shdrp[count]->sh_offset, SEEK_SET) != 0
6364 || bfd_bwrite (i_shdrp[count]->contents, amt, abfd) != amt)
6369 /* Write out the section header names. */
6370 t = elf_tdata (abfd);
6371 if (elf_shstrtab (abfd) != NULL
6372 && (bfd_seek (abfd, t->shstrtab_hdr.sh_offset, SEEK_SET) != 0
6373 || !_bfd_elf_strtab_emit (abfd, elf_shstrtab (abfd))))
6376 if (bed->elf_backend_final_write_processing)
6377 (*bed->elf_backend_final_write_processing) (abfd, elf_linker (abfd));
6379 if (!bed->s->write_shdrs_and_ehdr (abfd))
6382 /* This is last since write_shdrs_and_ehdr can touch i_shdrp[0]. */
6383 if (t->o->build_id.after_write_object_contents != NULL)
6384 return (*t->o->build_id.after_write_object_contents) (abfd);
6390 _bfd_elf_write_corefile_contents (bfd *abfd)
6392 /* Hopefully this can be done just like an object file. */
6393 return _bfd_elf_write_object_contents (abfd);
6396 /* Given a section, search the header to find them. */
6399 _bfd_elf_section_from_bfd_section (bfd *abfd, struct bfd_section *asect)
6401 const struct elf_backend_data *bed;
6402 unsigned int sec_index;
6404 if (elf_section_data (asect) != NULL
6405 && elf_section_data (asect)->this_idx != 0)
6406 return elf_section_data (asect)->this_idx;
6408 if (bfd_is_abs_section (asect))
6409 sec_index = SHN_ABS;
6410 else if (bfd_is_com_section (asect))
6411 sec_index = SHN_COMMON;
6412 else if (bfd_is_und_section (asect))
6413 sec_index = SHN_UNDEF;
6415 sec_index = SHN_BAD;
6417 bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
6418 if (bed->elf_backend_section_from_bfd_section)
6420 int retval = sec_index;
6422 if ((*bed->elf_backend_section_from_bfd_section) (abfd, asect, &retval))
6426 if (sec_index == SHN_BAD)
6427 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_nonrepresentable_section);
6432 /* Given a BFD symbol, return the index in the ELF symbol table, or -1
6436 _bfd_elf_symbol_from_bfd_symbol (bfd *abfd, asymbol **asym_ptr_ptr)
6438 asymbol *asym_ptr = *asym_ptr_ptr;
6440 flagword flags = asym_ptr->flags;
6442 /* When gas creates relocations against local labels, it creates its
6443 own symbol for the section, but does put the symbol into the
6444 symbol chain, so udata is 0. When the linker is generating
6445 relocatable output, this section symbol may be for one of the
6446 input sections rather than the output section. */
6447 if (asym_ptr->udata.i == 0
6448 && (flags & BSF_SECTION_SYM)
6449 && asym_ptr->section)
6454 sec = asym_ptr->section;
6455 if (sec->owner != abfd && sec->output_section != NULL)
6456 sec = sec->output_section;
6457 if (sec->owner == abfd
6458 && (indx = sec->index) < elf_num_section_syms (abfd)
6459 && elf_section_syms (abfd)[indx] != NULL)
6460 asym_ptr->udata.i = elf_section_syms (abfd)[indx]->udata.i;
6463 idx = asym_ptr->udata.i;
6467 /* This case can occur when using --strip-symbol on a symbol
6468 which is used in a relocation entry. */
6470 /* xgettext:c-format */
6471 (_("%B: symbol `%s' required but not present"),
6472 abfd, bfd_asymbol_name (asym_ptr));
6473 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_no_symbols);
6480 "elf_symbol_from_bfd_symbol 0x%.8lx, name = %s, sym num = %d, flags = 0x%.8x\n",
6481 (long) asym_ptr, asym_ptr->name, idx, flags);
6489 /* Rewrite program header information. */
6492 rewrite_elf_program_header (bfd *ibfd, bfd *obfd)
6494 Elf_Internal_Ehdr *iehdr;
6495 struct elf_segment_map *map;
6496 struct elf_segment_map *map_first;
6497 struct elf_segment_map **pointer_to_map;
6498 Elf_Internal_Phdr *segment;
6501 unsigned int num_segments;
6502 bfd_boolean phdr_included = FALSE;
6503 bfd_boolean p_paddr_valid;
6504 bfd_vma maxpagesize;
6505 struct elf_segment_map *phdr_adjust_seg = NULL;
6506 unsigned int phdr_adjust_num = 0;
6507 const struct elf_backend_data *bed;
6509 bed = get_elf_backend_data (ibfd);
6510 iehdr = elf_elfheader (ibfd);
6513 pointer_to_map = &map_first;
6515 num_segments = elf_elfheader (ibfd)->e_phnum;
6516 maxpagesize = get_elf_backend_data (obfd)->maxpagesize;
6518 /* Returns the end address of the segment + 1. */
6519 #define SEGMENT_END(segment, start) \
6520 (start + (segment->p_memsz > segment->p_filesz \
6521 ? segment->p_memsz : segment->p_filesz))
6523 #define SECTION_SIZE(section, segment) \
6524 (((section->flags & (SEC_HAS_CONTENTS | SEC_THREAD_LOCAL)) \
6525 != SEC_THREAD_LOCAL || segment->p_type == PT_TLS) \
6526 ? section->size : 0)
6528 /* Returns TRUE if the given section is contained within
6529 the given segment. VMA addresses are compared. */
6530 #define IS_CONTAINED_BY_VMA(section, segment) \
6531 (section->vma >= segment->p_vaddr \
6532 && (section->vma + SECTION_SIZE (section, segment) \
6533 <= (SEGMENT_END (segment, segment->p_vaddr))))
6535 /* Returns TRUE if the given section is contained within
6536 the given segment. LMA addresses are compared. */
6537 #define IS_CONTAINED_BY_LMA(section, segment, base) \
6538 (section->lma >= base \
6539 && (section->lma + SECTION_SIZE (section, segment) \
6540 <= SEGMENT_END (segment, base)))
6542 /* Handle PT_NOTE segment. */
6543 #define IS_NOTE(p, s) \
6544 (p->p_type == PT_NOTE \
6545 && elf_section_type (s) == SHT_NOTE \
6546 && (bfd_vma) s->filepos >= p->p_offset \
6547 && ((bfd_vma) s->filepos + s->size \
6548 <= p->p_offset + p->p_filesz))
6550 /* Special case: corefile "NOTE" section containing regs, prpsinfo
6552 #define IS_COREFILE_NOTE(p, s) \
6554 && bfd_get_format (ibfd) == bfd_core \
6558 /* The complicated case when p_vaddr is 0 is to handle the Solaris
6559 linker, which generates a PT_INTERP section with p_vaddr and
6560 p_memsz set to 0. */
6561 #define IS_SOLARIS_PT_INTERP(p, s) \
6563 && p->p_paddr == 0 \
6564 && p->p_memsz == 0 \
6565 && p->p_filesz > 0 \
6566 && (s->flags & SEC_HAS_CONTENTS) != 0 \
6568 && (bfd_vma) s->filepos >= p->p_offset \
6569 && ((bfd_vma) s->filepos + s->size \
6570 <= p->p_offset + p->p_filesz))
6572 /* Decide if the given section should be included in the given segment.
6573 A section will be included if:
6574 1. It is within the address space of the segment -- we use the LMA
6575 if that is set for the segment and the VMA otherwise,
6576 2. It is an allocated section or a NOTE section in a PT_NOTE
6578 3. There is an output section associated with it,
6579 4. The section has not already been allocated to a previous segment.
6580 5. PT_GNU_STACK segments do not include any sections.
6581 6. PT_TLS segment includes only SHF_TLS sections.
6582 7. SHF_TLS sections are only in PT_TLS or PT_LOAD segments.
6583 8. PT_DYNAMIC should not contain empty sections at the beginning
6584 (with the possible exception of .dynamic). */
6585 #define IS_SECTION_IN_INPUT_SEGMENT(section, segment, bed) \
6586 ((((segment->p_paddr \
6587 ? IS_CONTAINED_BY_LMA (section, segment, segment->p_paddr) \
6588 : IS_CONTAINED_BY_VMA (section, segment)) \
6589 && (section->flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0) \
6590 || IS_NOTE (segment, section)) \
6591 && segment->p_type != PT_GNU_STACK \
6592 && (segment->p_type != PT_TLS \
6593 || (section->flags & SEC_THREAD_LOCAL)) \
6594 && (segment->p_type == PT_LOAD \
6595 || segment->p_type == PT_TLS \
6596 || (section->flags & SEC_THREAD_LOCAL) == 0) \
6597 && (segment->p_type != PT_DYNAMIC \
6598 || SECTION_SIZE (section, segment) > 0 \
6599 || (segment->p_paddr \
6600 ? segment->p_paddr != section->lma \
6601 : segment->p_vaddr != section->vma) \
6602 || (strcmp (bfd_get_section_name (ibfd, section), ".dynamic") \
6604 && !section->segment_mark)
6606 /* If the output section of a section in the input segment is NULL,
6607 it is removed from the corresponding output segment. */
6608 #define INCLUDE_SECTION_IN_SEGMENT(section, segment, bed) \
6609 (IS_SECTION_IN_INPUT_SEGMENT (section, segment, bed) \
6610 && section->output_section != NULL)
6612 /* Returns TRUE iff seg1 starts after the end of seg2. */
6613 #define SEGMENT_AFTER_SEGMENT(seg1, seg2, field) \
6614 (seg1->field >= SEGMENT_END (seg2, seg2->field))
6616 /* Returns TRUE iff seg1 and seg2 overlap. Segments overlap iff both
6617 their VMA address ranges and their LMA address ranges overlap.
6618 It is possible to have overlapping VMA ranges without overlapping LMA
6619 ranges. RedBoot images for example can have both .data and .bss mapped
6620 to the same VMA range, but with the .data section mapped to a different
6622 #define SEGMENT_OVERLAPS(seg1, seg2) \
6623 ( !(SEGMENT_AFTER_SEGMENT (seg1, seg2, p_vaddr) \
6624 || SEGMENT_AFTER_SEGMENT (seg2, seg1, p_vaddr)) \
6625 && !(SEGMENT_AFTER_SEGMENT (seg1, seg2, p_paddr) \
6626 || SEGMENT_AFTER_SEGMENT (seg2, seg1, p_paddr)))
6628 /* Initialise the segment mark field. */
6629 for (section = ibfd->sections; section != NULL; section = section->next)
6630 section->segment_mark = FALSE;
6632 /* The Solaris linker creates program headers in which all the
6633 p_paddr fields are zero. When we try to objcopy or strip such a
6634 file, we get confused. Check for this case, and if we find it
6635 don't set the p_paddr_valid fields. */
6636 p_paddr_valid = FALSE;
6637 for (i = 0, segment = elf_tdata (ibfd)->phdr;
6640 if (segment->p_paddr != 0)
6642 p_paddr_valid = TRUE;
6646 /* Scan through the segments specified in the program header
6647 of the input BFD. For this first scan we look for overlaps
6648 in the loadable segments. These can be created by weird
6649 parameters to objcopy. Also, fix some solaris weirdness. */
6650 for (i = 0, segment = elf_tdata (ibfd)->phdr;
6655 Elf_Internal_Phdr *segment2;
6657 if (segment->p_type == PT_INTERP)
6658 for (section = ibfd->sections; section; section = section->next)
6659 if (IS_SOLARIS_PT_INTERP (segment, section))
6661 /* Mininal change so that the normal section to segment
6662 assignment code will work. */
6663 segment->p_vaddr = section->vma;
6667 if (segment->p_type != PT_LOAD)
6669 /* Remove PT_GNU_RELRO segment. */
6670 if (segment->p_type == PT_GNU_RELRO)
6671 segment->p_type = PT_NULL;
6675 /* Determine if this segment overlaps any previous segments. */
6676 for (j = 0, segment2 = elf_tdata (ibfd)->phdr; j < i; j++, segment2++)
6678 bfd_signed_vma extra_length;
6680 if (segment2->p_type != PT_LOAD
6681 || !SEGMENT_OVERLAPS (segment, segment2))
6684 /* Merge the two segments together. */
6685 if (segment2->p_vaddr < segment->p_vaddr)
6687 /* Extend SEGMENT2 to include SEGMENT and then delete
6689 extra_length = (SEGMENT_END (segment, segment->p_vaddr)
6690 - SEGMENT_END (segment2, segment2->p_vaddr));
6692 if (extra_length > 0)
6694 segment2->p_memsz += extra_length;
6695 segment2->p_filesz += extra_length;
6698 segment->p_type = PT_NULL;
6700 /* Since we have deleted P we must restart the outer loop. */
6702 segment = elf_tdata (ibfd)->phdr;
6707 /* Extend SEGMENT to include SEGMENT2 and then delete
6709 extra_length = (SEGMENT_END (segment2, segment2->p_vaddr)
6710 - SEGMENT_END (segment, segment->p_vaddr));
6712 if (extra_length > 0)
6714 segment->p_memsz += extra_length;
6715 segment->p_filesz += extra_length;
6718 segment2->p_type = PT_NULL;
6723 /* The second scan attempts to assign sections to segments. */
6724 for (i = 0, segment = elf_tdata (ibfd)->phdr;
6728 unsigned int section_count;
6729 asection **sections;
6730 asection *output_section;
6732 bfd_vma matching_lma;
6733 bfd_vma suggested_lma;
6736 asection *first_section;
6737 bfd_boolean first_matching_lma;
6738 bfd_boolean first_suggested_lma;
6740 if (segment->p_type == PT_NULL)
6743 first_section = NULL;
6744 /* Compute how many sections might be placed into this segment. */
6745 for (section = ibfd->sections, section_count = 0;
6747 section = section->next)
6749 /* Find the first section in the input segment, which may be
6750 removed from the corresponding output segment. */
6751 if (IS_SECTION_IN_INPUT_SEGMENT (section, segment, bed))
6753 if (first_section == NULL)
6754 first_section = section;
6755 if (section->output_section != NULL)
6760 /* Allocate a segment map big enough to contain
6761 all of the sections we have selected. */
6762 amt = sizeof (struct elf_segment_map);
6763 amt += ((bfd_size_type) section_count - 1) * sizeof (asection *);
6764 map = (struct elf_segment_map *) bfd_zalloc (obfd, amt);
6768 /* Initialise the fields of the segment map. Default to
6769 using the physical address of the segment in the input BFD. */
6771 map->p_type = segment->p_type;
6772 map->p_flags = segment->p_flags;
6773 map->p_flags_valid = 1;
6775 /* If the first section in the input segment is removed, there is
6776 no need to preserve segment physical address in the corresponding
6778 if (!first_section || first_section->output_section != NULL)
6780 map->p_paddr = segment->p_paddr;
6781 map->p_paddr_valid = p_paddr_valid;
6784 /* Determine if this segment contains the ELF file header
6785 and if it contains the program headers themselves. */
6786 map->includes_filehdr = (segment->p_offset == 0
6787 && segment->p_filesz >= iehdr->e_ehsize);
6788 map->includes_phdrs = 0;
6790 if (!phdr_included || segment->p_type != PT_LOAD)
6792 map->includes_phdrs =
6793 (segment->p_offset <= (bfd_vma) iehdr->e_phoff
6794 && (segment->p_offset + segment->p_filesz
6795 >= ((bfd_vma) iehdr->e_phoff
6796 + iehdr->e_phnum * iehdr->e_phentsize)));
6798 if (segment->p_type == PT_LOAD && map->includes_phdrs)
6799 phdr_included = TRUE;
6802 if (section_count == 0)
6804 /* Special segments, such as the PT_PHDR segment, may contain
6805 no sections, but ordinary, loadable segments should contain
6806 something. They are allowed by the ELF spec however, so only
6807 a warning is produced.
6808 There is however the valid use case of embedded systems which
6809 have segments with p_filesz of 0 and a p_memsz > 0 to initialize
6810 flash memory with zeros. No warning is shown for that case. */
6811 if (segment->p_type == PT_LOAD
6812 && (segment->p_filesz > 0 || segment->p_memsz == 0))
6813 /* xgettext:c-format */
6814 _bfd_error_handler (_("%B: warning: Empty loadable segment detected"
6815 " at vaddr=%#Lx, is this intentional?"),
6816 ibfd, segment->p_vaddr);
6819 *pointer_to_map = map;
6820 pointer_to_map = &map->next;
6825 /* Now scan the sections in the input BFD again and attempt
6826 to add their corresponding output sections to the segment map.
6827 The problem here is how to handle an output section which has
6828 been moved (ie had its LMA changed). There are four possibilities:
6830 1. None of the sections have been moved.
6831 In this case we can continue to use the segment LMA from the
6834 2. All of the sections have been moved by the same amount.
6835 In this case we can change the segment's LMA to match the LMA
6836 of the first section.
6838 3. Some of the sections have been moved, others have not.
6839 In this case those sections which have not been moved can be
6840 placed in the current segment which will have to have its size,
6841 and possibly its LMA changed, and a new segment or segments will
6842 have to be created to contain the other sections.
6844 4. The sections have been moved, but not by the same amount.
6845 In this case we can change the segment's LMA to match the LMA
6846 of the first section and we will have to create a new segment
6847 or segments to contain the other sections.
6849 In order to save time, we allocate an array to hold the section
6850 pointers that we are interested in. As these sections get assigned
6851 to a segment, they are removed from this array. */
6853 sections = (asection **) bfd_malloc2 (section_count, sizeof (asection *));
6854 if (sections == NULL)
6857 /* Step One: Scan for segment vs section LMA conflicts.
6858 Also add the sections to the section array allocated above.
6859 Also add the sections to the current segment. In the common
6860 case, where the sections have not been moved, this means that
6861 we have completely filled the segment, and there is nothing
6866 first_matching_lma = TRUE;
6867 first_suggested_lma = TRUE;
6869 for (section = first_section, j = 0;
6871 section = section->next)
6873 if (INCLUDE_SECTION_IN_SEGMENT (section, segment, bed))
6875 output_section = section->output_section;
6877 sections[j++] = section;
6879 /* The Solaris native linker always sets p_paddr to 0.
6880 We try to catch that case here, and set it to the
6881 correct value. Note - some backends require that
6882 p_paddr be left as zero. */
6884 && segment->p_vaddr != 0
6885 && !bed->want_p_paddr_set_to_zero
6887 && output_section->lma != 0
6888 && output_section->vma == (segment->p_vaddr
6889 + (map->includes_filehdr
6892 + (map->includes_phdrs
6894 * iehdr->e_phentsize)
6896 map->p_paddr = segment->p_vaddr;
6898 /* Match up the physical address of the segment with the
6899 LMA address of the output section. */
6900 if (IS_CONTAINED_BY_LMA (output_section, segment, map->p_paddr)
6901 || IS_COREFILE_NOTE (segment, section)
6902 || (bed->want_p_paddr_set_to_zero
6903 && IS_CONTAINED_BY_VMA (output_section, segment)))
6905 if (first_matching_lma || output_section->lma < matching_lma)
6907 matching_lma = output_section->lma;
6908 first_matching_lma = FALSE;
6911 /* We assume that if the section fits within the segment
6912 then it does not overlap any other section within that
6914 map->sections[isec++] = output_section;
6916 else if (first_suggested_lma)
6918 suggested_lma = output_section->lma;
6919 first_suggested_lma = FALSE;
6922 if (j == section_count)
6927 BFD_ASSERT (j == section_count);
6929 /* Step Two: Adjust the physical address of the current segment,
6931 if (isec == section_count)
6933 /* All of the sections fitted within the segment as currently
6934 specified. This is the default case. Add the segment to
6935 the list of built segments and carry on to process the next
6936 program header in the input BFD. */
6937 map->count = section_count;
6938 *pointer_to_map = map;
6939 pointer_to_map = &map->next;
6942 && !bed->want_p_paddr_set_to_zero
6943 && matching_lma != map->p_paddr
6944 && !map->includes_filehdr
6945 && !map->includes_phdrs)
6946 /* There is some padding before the first section in the
6947 segment. So, we must account for that in the output
6949 map->p_vaddr_offset = matching_lma - map->p_paddr;
6956 if (!first_matching_lma)
6958 /* At least one section fits inside the current segment.
6959 Keep it, but modify its physical address to match the
6960 LMA of the first section that fitted. */
6961 map->p_paddr = matching_lma;
6965 /* None of the sections fitted inside the current segment.
6966 Change the current segment's physical address to match
6967 the LMA of the first section. */
6968 map->p_paddr = suggested_lma;
6971 /* Offset the segment physical address from the lma
6972 to allow for space taken up by elf headers. */
6973 if (map->includes_filehdr)
6975 if (map->p_paddr >= iehdr->e_ehsize)
6976 map->p_paddr -= iehdr->e_ehsize;
6979 map->includes_filehdr = FALSE;
6980 map->includes_phdrs = FALSE;
6984 if (map->includes_phdrs)
6986 if (map->p_paddr >= iehdr->e_phnum * iehdr->e_phentsize)
6988 map->p_paddr -= iehdr->e_phnum * iehdr->e_phentsize;
6990 /* iehdr->e_phnum is just an estimate of the number
6991 of program headers that we will need. Make a note
6992 here of the number we used and the segment we chose
6993 to hold these headers, so that we can adjust the
6994 offset when we know the correct value. */
6995 phdr_adjust_num = iehdr->e_phnum;
6996 phdr_adjust_seg = map;
6999 map->includes_phdrs = FALSE;
7003 /* Step Three: Loop over the sections again, this time assigning
7004 those that fit to the current segment and removing them from the
7005 sections array; but making sure not to leave large gaps. Once all
7006 possible sections have been assigned to the current segment it is
7007 added to the list of built segments and if sections still remain
7008 to be assigned, a new segment is constructed before repeating
7015 first_suggested_lma = TRUE;
7017 /* Fill the current segment with sections that fit. */
7018 for (j = 0; j < section_count; j++)
7020 section = sections[j];
7022 if (section == NULL)
7025 output_section = section->output_section;
7027 BFD_ASSERT (output_section != NULL);
7029 if (IS_CONTAINED_BY_LMA (output_section, segment, map->p_paddr)
7030 || IS_COREFILE_NOTE (segment, section))
7032 if (map->count == 0)
7034 /* If the first section in a segment does not start at
7035 the beginning of the segment, then something is
7037 if (output_section->lma
7039 + (map->includes_filehdr ? iehdr->e_ehsize : 0)
7040 + (map->includes_phdrs
7041 ? iehdr->e_phnum * iehdr->e_phentsize
7049 prev_sec = map->sections[map->count - 1];
7051 /* If the gap between the end of the previous section
7052 and the start of this section is more than
7053 maxpagesize then we need to start a new segment. */
7054 if ((BFD_ALIGN (prev_sec->lma + prev_sec->size,
7056 < BFD_ALIGN (output_section->lma, maxpagesize))
7057 || (prev_sec->lma + prev_sec->size
7058 > output_section->lma))
7060 if (first_suggested_lma)
7062 suggested_lma = output_section->lma;
7063 first_suggested_lma = FALSE;
7070 map->sections[map->count++] = output_section;
7073 section->segment_mark = TRUE;
7075 else if (first_suggested_lma)
7077 suggested_lma = output_section->lma;
7078 first_suggested_lma = FALSE;
7082 BFD_ASSERT (map->count > 0);
7084 /* Add the current segment to the list of built segments. */
7085 *pointer_to_map = map;
7086 pointer_to_map = &map->next;
7088 if (isec < section_count)
7090 /* We still have not allocated all of the sections to
7091 segments. Create a new segment here, initialise it
7092 and carry on looping. */
7093 amt = sizeof (struct elf_segment_map);
7094 amt += ((bfd_size_type) section_count - 1) * sizeof (asection *);
7095 map = (struct elf_segment_map *) bfd_zalloc (obfd, amt);
7102 /* Initialise the fields of the segment map. Set the physical
7103 physical address to the LMA of the first section that has
7104 not yet been assigned. */
7106 map->p_type = segment->p_type;
7107 map->p_flags = segment->p_flags;
7108 map->p_flags_valid = 1;
7109 map->p_paddr = suggested_lma;
7110 map->p_paddr_valid = p_paddr_valid;
7111 map->includes_filehdr = 0;
7112 map->includes_phdrs = 0;
7115 while (isec < section_count);
7120 elf_seg_map (obfd) = map_first;
7122 /* If we had to estimate the number of program headers that were
7123 going to be needed, then check our estimate now and adjust
7124 the offset if necessary. */
7125 if (phdr_adjust_seg != NULL)
7129 for (count = 0, map = map_first; map != NULL; map = map->next)
7132 if (count > phdr_adjust_num)
7133 phdr_adjust_seg->p_paddr
7134 -= (count - phdr_adjust_num) * iehdr->e_phentsize;
7139 #undef IS_CONTAINED_BY_VMA
7140 #undef IS_CONTAINED_BY_LMA
7142 #undef IS_COREFILE_NOTE
7143 #undef IS_SOLARIS_PT_INTERP
7144 #undef IS_SECTION_IN_INPUT_SEGMENT
7145 #undef INCLUDE_SECTION_IN_SEGMENT
7146 #undef SEGMENT_AFTER_SEGMENT
7147 #undef SEGMENT_OVERLAPS
7151 /* Copy ELF program header information. */
7154 copy_elf_program_header (bfd *ibfd, bfd *obfd)
7156 Elf_Internal_Ehdr *iehdr;
7157 struct elf_segment_map *map;
7158 struct elf_segment_map *map_first;
7159 struct elf_segment_map **pointer_to_map;
7160 Elf_Internal_Phdr *segment;
7162 unsigned int num_segments;
7163 bfd_boolean phdr_included = FALSE;
7164 bfd_boolean p_paddr_valid;
7166 iehdr = elf_elfheader (ibfd);
7169 pointer_to_map = &map_first;
7171 /* If all the segment p_paddr fields are zero, don't set
7172 map->p_paddr_valid. */
7173 p_paddr_valid = FALSE;
7174 num_segments = elf_elfheader (ibfd)->e_phnum;
7175 for (i = 0, segment = elf_tdata (ibfd)->phdr;
7178 if (segment->p_paddr != 0)
7180 p_paddr_valid = TRUE;
7184 for (i = 0, segment = elf_tdata (ibfd)->phdr;
7189 unsigned int section_count;
7191 Elf_Internal_Shdr *this_hdr;
7192 asection *first_section = NULL;
7193 asection *lowest_section;
7195 /* Compute how many sections are in this segment. */
7196 for (section = ibfd->sections, section_count = 0;
7198 section = section->next)
7200 this_hdr = &(elf_section_data(section)->this_hdr);
7201 if (ELF_SECTION_IN_SEGMENT (this_hdr, segment))
7203 if (first_section == NULL)
7204 first_section = section;
7209 /* Allocate a segment map big enough to contain
7210 all of the sections we have selected. */
7211 amt = sizeof (struct elf_segment_map);
7212 if (section_count != 0)
7213 amt += ((bfd_size_type) section_count - 1) * sizeof (asection *);
7214 map = (struct elf_segment_map *) bfd_zalloc (obfd, amt);
7218 /* Initialize the fields of the output segment map with the
7221 map->p_type = segment->p_type;
7222 map->p_flags = segment->p_flags;
7223 map->p_flags_valid = 1;
7224 map->p_paddr = segment->p_paddr;
7225 map->p_paddr_valid = p_paddr_valid;
7226 map->p_align = segment->p_align;
7227 map->p_align_valid = 1;
7228 map->p_vaddr_offset = 0;
7230 if (map->p_type == PT_GNU_RELRO
7231 || map->p_type == PT_GNU_STACK)
7233 /* The PT_GNU_RELRO segment may contain the first a few
7234 bytes in the .got.plt section even if the whole .got.plt
7235 section isn't in the PT_GNU_RELRO segment. We won't
7236 change the size of the PT_GNU_RELRO segment.
7237 Similarly, PT_GNU_STACK size is significant on uclinux
7239 map->p_size = segment->p_memsz;
7240 map->p_size_valid = 1;
7243 /* Determine if this segment contains the ELF file header
7244 and if it contains the program headers themselves. */
7245 map->includes_filehdr = (segment->p_offset == 0
7246 && segment->p_filesz >= iehdr->e_ehsize);
7248 map->includes_phdrs = 0;
7249 if (! phdr_included || segment->p_type != PT_LOAD)
7251 map->includes_phdrs =
7252 (segment->p_offset <= (bfd_vma) iehdr->e_phoff
7253 && (segment->p_offset + segment->p_filesz
7254 >= ((bfd_vma) iehdr->e_phoff
7255 + iehdr->e_phnum * iehdr->e_phentsize)));
7257 if (segment->p_type == PT_LOAD && map->includes_phdrs)
7258 phdr_included = TRUE;
7261 lowest_section = NULL;
7262 if (section_count != 0)
7264 unsigned int isec = 0;
7266 for (section = first_section;
7268 section = section->next)
7270 this_hdr = &(elf_section_data(section)->this_hdr);
7271 if (ELF_SECTION_IN_SEGMENT (this_hdr, segment))
7273 map->sections[isec++] = section->output_section;
7274 if ((section->flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0)
7278 if (lowest_section == NULL
7279 || section->lma < lowest_section->lma)
7280 lowest_section = section;
7282 /* Section lmas are set up from PT_LOAD header
7283 p_paddr in _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr.
7284 If this header has a p_paddr that disagrees
7285 with the section lma, flag the p_paddr as
7287 if ((section->flags & SEC_LOAD) != 0)
7288 seg_off = this_hdr->sh_offset - segment->p_offset;
7290 seg_off = this_hdr->sh_addr - segment->p_vaddr;
7291 if (section->lma - segment->p_paddr != seg_off)
7292 map->p_paddr_valid = FALSE;
7294 if (isec == section_count)
7300 if (map->includes_filehdr && lowest_section != NULL)
7301 /* We need to keep the space used by the headers fixed. */
7302 map->header_size = lowest_section->vma - segment->p_vaddr;
7304 if (!map->includes_phdrs
7305 && !map->includes_filehdr
7306 && map->p_paddr_valid)
7307 /* There is some other padding before the first section. */
7308 map->p_vaddr_offset = ((lowest_section ? lowest_section->lma : 0)
7309 - segment->p_paddr);
7311 map->count = section_count;
7312 *pointer_to_map = map;
7313 pointer_to_map = &map->next;
7316 elf_seg_map (obfd) = map_first;
7320 /* Copy private BFD data. This copies or rewrites ELF program header
7324 copy_private_bfd_data (bfd *ibfd, bfd *obfd)
7326 if (bfd_get_flavour (ibfd) != bfd_target_elf_flavour
7327 || bfd_get_flavour (obfd) != bfd_target_elf_flavour)
7330 if (elf_tdata (ibfd)->phdr == NULL)
7333 if (ibfd->xvec == obfd->xvec)
7335 /* Check to see if any sections in the input BFD
7336 covered by ELF program header have changed. */
7337 Elf_Internal_Phdr *segment;
7338 asection *section, *osec;
7339 unsigned int i, num_segments;
7340 Elf_Internal_Shdr *this_hdr;
7341 const struct elf_backend_data *bed;
7343 bed = get_elf_backend_data (ibfd);
7345 /* Regenerate the segment map if p_paddr is set to 0. */
7346 if (bed->want_p_paddr_set_to_zero)
7349 /* Initialize the segment mark field. */
7350 for (section = obfd->sections; section != NULL;
7351 section = section->next)
7352 section->segment_mark = FALSE;
7354 num_segments = elf_elfheader (ibfd)->e_phnum;
7355 for (i = 0, segment = elf_tdata (ibfd)->phdr;
7359 /* PR binutils/3535. The Solaris linker always sets the p_paddr
7360 and p_memsz fields of special segments (DYNAMIC, INTERP) to 0
7361 which severly confuses things, so always regenerate the segment
7362 map in this case. */
7363 if (segment->p_paddr == 0
7364 && segment->p_memsz == 0
7365 && (segment->p_type == PT_INTERP || segment->p_type == PT_DYNAMIC))
7368 for (section = ibfd->sections;
7369 section != NULL; section = section->next)
7371 /* We mark the output section so that we know it comes
7372 from the input BFD. */
7373 osec = section->output_section;
7375 osec->segment_mark = TRUE;
7377 /* Check if this section is covered by the segment. */
7378 this_hdr = &(elf_section_data(section)->this_hdr);
7379 if (ELF_SECTION_IN_SEGMENT (this_hdr, segment))
7381 /* FIXME: Check if its output section is changed or
7382 removed. What else do we need to check? */
7384 || section->flags != osec->flags
7385 || section->lma != osec->lma
7386 || section->vma != osec->vma
7387 || section->size != osec->size
7388 || section->rawsize != osec->rawsize
7389 || section->alignment_power != osec->alignment_power)
7395 /* Check to see if any output section do not come from the
7397 for (section = obfd->sections; section != NULL;
7398 section = section->next)
7400 if (!section->segment_mark)
7403 section->segment_mark = FALSE;
7406 return copy_elf_program_header (ibfd, obfd);
7410 if (ibfd->xvec == obfd->xvec)
7412 /* When rewriting program header, set the output maxpagesize to
7413 the maximum alignment of input PT_LOAD segments. */
7414 Elf_Internal_Phdr *segment;
7416 unsigned int num_segments = elf_elfheader (ibfd)->e_phnum;
7417 bfd_vma maxpagesize = 0;
7419 for (i = 0, segment = elf_tdata (ibfd)->phdr;
7422 if (segment->p_type == PT_LOAD
7423 && maxpagesize < segment->p_align)
7425 /* PR 17512: file: f17299af. */
7426 if (segment->p_align > (bfd_vma) 1 << ((sizeof (bfd_vma) * 8) - 2))
7427 /* xgettext:c-format */
7428 _bfd_error_handler (_("%B: warning: segment alignment of %#Lx"
7430 ibfd, segment->p_align);
7432 maxpagesize = segment->p_align;
7435 if (maxpagesize != get_elf_backend_data (obfd)->maxpagesize)
7436 bfd_emul_set_maxpagesize (bfd_get_target (obfd), maxpagesize);
7439 return rewrite_elf_program_header (ibfd, obfd);
7442 /* Initialize private output section information from input section. */
7445 _bfd_elf_init_private_section_data (bfd *ibfd,
7449 struct bfd_link_info *link_info)
7452 Elf_Internal_Shdr *ihdr, *ohdr;
7453 bfd_boolean final_link = (link_info != NULL
7454 && !bfd_link_relocatable (link_info));
7456 if (ibfd->xvec->flavour != bfd_target_elf_flavour
7457 || obfd->xvec->flavour != bfd_target_elf_flavour)
7460 BFD_ASSERT (elf_section_data (osec) != NULL);
7462 /* For objcopy and relocatable link, don't copy the output ELF
7463 section type from input if the output BFD section flags have been
7464 set to something different. For a final link allow some flags
7465 that the linker clears to differ. */
7466 if (elf_section_type (osec) == SHT_NULL
7467 && (osec->flags == isec->flags
7469 && ((osec->flags ^ isec->flags)
7470 & ~(SEC_LINK_ONCE | SEC_LINK_DUPLICATES | SEC_RELOC)) == 0)))
7471 elf_section_type (osec) = elf_section_type (isec);
7473 /* FIXME: Is this correct for all OS/PROC specific flags? */
7474 elf_section_flags (osec) |= (elf_section_flags (isec)
7475 & (SHF_MASKOS | SHF_MASKPROC));
7477 /* Copy sh_info from input for mbind section. */
7478 if (elf_section_flags (isec) & SHF_GNU_MBIND)
7479 elf_section_data (osec)->this_hdr.sh_info
7480 = elf_section_data (isec)->this_hdr.sh_info;
7482 /* Set things up for objcopy and relocatable link. The output
7483 SHT_GROUP section will have its elf_next_in_group pointing back
7484 to the input group members. Ignore linker created group section.
7485 See elfNN_ia64_object_p in elfxx-ia64.c. */
7486 if ((link_info == NULL
7487 || !link_info->resolve_section_groups)
7488 && (elf_sec_group (isec) == NULL
7489 || (elf_sec_group (isec)->flags & SEC_LINKER_CREATED) == 0))
7491 if (elf_section_flags (isec) & SHF_GROUP)
7492 elf_section_flags (osec) |= SHF_GROUP;
7493 elf_next_in_group (osec) = elf_next_in_group (isec);
7494 elf_section_data (osec)->group = elf_section_data (isec)->group;
7497 /* If not decompress, preserve SHF_COMPRESSED. */
7498 if (!final_link && (ibfd->flags & BFD_DECOMPRESS) == 0)
7499 elf_section_flags (osec) |= (elf_section_flags (isec)
7502 ihdr = &elf_section_data (isec)->this_hdr;
7504 /* We need to handle elf_linked_to_section for SHF_LINK_ORDER. We
7505 don't use the output section of the linked-to section since it
7506 may be NULL at this point. */
7507 if ((ihdr->sh_flags & SHF_LINK_ORDER) != 0)
7509 ohdr = &elf_section_data (osec)->this_hdr;
7510 ohdr->sh_flags |= SHF_LINK_ORDER;
7511 elf_linked_to_section (osec) = elf_linked_to_section (isec);
7514 osec->use_rela_p = isec->use_rela_p;
7519 /* Copy private section information. This copies over the entsize
7520 field, and sometimes the info field. */
7523 _bfd_elf_copy_private_section_data (bfd *ibfd,
7528 Elf_Internal_Shdr *ihdr, *ohdr;
7530 if (ibfd->xvec->flavour != bfd_target_elf_flavour
7531 || obfd->xvec->flavour != bfd_target_elf_flavour)
7534 ihdr = &elf_section_data (isec)->this_hdr;
7535 ohdr = &elf_section_data (osec)->this_hdr;
7537 ohdr->sh_entsize = ihdr->sh_entsize;
7539 if (ihdr->sh_type == SHT_SYMTAB
7540 || ihdr->sh_type == SHT_DYNSYM
7541 || ihdr->sh_type == SHT_GNU_verneed
7542 || ihdr->sh_type == SHT_GNU_verdef)
7543 ohdr->sh_info = ihdr->sh_info;
7545 return _bfd_elf_init_private_section_data (ibfd, isec, obfd, osec,
7549 /* Look at all the SHT_GROUP sections in IBFD, making any adjustments
7550 necessary if we are removing either the SHT_GROUP section or any of
7551 the group member sections. DISCARDED is the value that a section's
7552 output_section has if the section will be discarded, NULL when this
7553 function is called from objcopy, bfd_abs_section_ptr when called
7557 _bfd_elf_fixup_group_sections (bfd *ibfd, asection *discarded)
7561 for (isec = ibfd->sections; isec != NULL; isec = isec->next)
7562 if (elf_section_type (isec) == SHT_GROUP)
7564 asection *first = elf_next_in_group (isec);
7565 asection *s = first;
7566 bfd_size_type removed = 0;
7570 /* If this member section is being output but the
7571 SHT_GROUP section is not, then clear the group info
7572 set up by _bfd_elf_copy_private_section_data. */
7573 if (s->output_section != discarded
7574 && isec->output_section == discarded)
7576 elf_section_flags (s->output_section) &= ~SHF_GROUP;
7577 elf_group_name (s->output_section) = NULL;
7579 /* Conversely, if the member section is not being output
7580 but the SHT_GROUP section is, then adjust its size. */
7581 else if (s->output_section == discarded
7582 && isec->output_section != discarded)
7584 s = elf_next_in_group (s);
7590 if (discarded != NULL)
7592 /* If we've been called for ld -r, then we need to
7593 adjust the input section size. This function may
7594 be called multiple times, so save the original
7596 if (isec->rawsize == 0)
7597 isec->rawsize = isec->size;
7598 isec->size = isec->rawsize - removed;
7602 /* Adjust the output section size when called from
7604 isec->output_section->size -= removed;
7612 /* Copy private header information. */
7615 _bfd_elf_copy_private_header_data (bfd *ibfd, bfd *obfd)
7617 if (bfd_get_flavour (ibfd) != bfd_target_elf_flavour
7618 || bfd_get_flavour (obfd) != bfd_target_elf_flavour)
7621 /* Copy over private BFD data if it has not already been copied.
7622 This must be done here, rather than in the copy_private_bfd_data
7623 entry point, because the latter is called after the section
7624 contents have been set, which means that the program headers have
7625 already been worked out. */
7626 if (elf_seg_map (obfd) == NULL && elf_tdata (ibfd)->phdr != NULL)
7628 if (! copy_private_bfd_data (ibfd, obfd))
7632 return _bfd_elf_fixup_group_sections (ibfd, NULL);
7635 /* Copy private symbol information. If this symbol is in a section
7636 which we did not map into a BFD section, try to map the section
7637 index correctly. We use special macro definitions for the mapped
7638 section indices; these definitions are interpreted by the
7639 swap_out_syms function. */
7641 #define MAP_ONESYMTAB (SHN_HIOS + 1)
7642 #define MAP_DYNSYMTAB (SHN_HIOS + 2)
7643 #define MAP_STRTAB (SHN_HIOS + 3)
7644 #define MAP_SHSTRTAB (SHN_HIOS + 4)
7645 #define MAP_SYM_SHNDX (SHN_HIOS + 5)
7648 _bfd_elf_copy_private_symbol_data (bfd *ibfd,
7653 elf_symbol_type *isym, *osym;
7655 if (bfd_get_flavour (ibfd) != bfd_target_elf_flavour
7656 || bfd_get_flavour (obfd) != bfd_target_elf_flavour)
7659 isym = elf_symbol_from (ibfd, isymarg);
7660 osym = elf_symbol_from (obfd, osymarg);
7663 && isym->internal_elf_sym.st_shndx != 0
7665 && bfd_is_abs_section (isym->symbol.section))
7669 shndx = isym->internal_elf_sym.st_shndx;
7670 if (shndx == elf_onesymtab (ibfd))
7671 shndx = MAP_ONESYMTAB;
7672 else if (shndx == elf_dynsymtab (ibfd))
7673 shndx = MAP_DYNSYMTAB;
7674 else if (shndx == elf_strtab_sec (ibfd))
7676 else if (shndx == elf_shstrtab_sec (ibfd))
7677 shndx = MAP_SHSTRTAB;
7678 else if (find_section_in_list (shndx, elf_symtab_shndx_list (ibfd)))
7679 shndx = MAP_SYM_SHNDX;
7680 osym->internal_elf_sym.st_shndx = shndx;
7686 /* Swap out the symbols. */
7689 swap_out_syms (bfd *abfd,
7690 struct elf_strtab_hash **sttp,
7693 const struct elf_backend_data *bed;
7696 struct elf_strtab_hash *stt;
7697 Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr;
7698 Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_shndx_hdr;
7699 Elf_Internal_Shdr *symstrtab_hdr;
7700 struct elf_sym_strtab *symstrtab;
7701 bfd_byte *outbound_syms;
7702 bfd_byte *outbound_shndx;
7703 unsigned long outbound_syms_index;
7704 unsigned long outbound_shndx_index;
7706 unsigned int num_locals;
7708 bfd_boolean name_local_sections;
7710 if (!elf_map_symbols (abfd, &num_locals))
7713 /* Dump out the symtabs. */
7714 stt = _bfd_elf_strtab_init ();
7718 bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
7719 symcount = bfd_get_symcount (abfd);
7720 symtab_hdr = &elf_tdata (abfd)->symtab_hdr;
7721 symtab_hdr->sh_type = SHT_SYMTAB;
7722 symtab_hdr->sh_entsize = bed->s->sizeof_sym;
7723 symtab_hdr->sh_size = symtab_hdr->sh_entsize * (symcount + 1);
7724 symtab_hdr->sh_info = num_locals + 1;
7725 symtab_hdr->sh_addralign = (bfd_vma) 1 << bed->s->log_file_align;
7727 symstrtab_hdr = &elf_tdata (abfd)->strtab_hdr;
7728 symstrtab_hdr->sh_type = SHT_STRTAB;
7730 /* Allocate buffer to swap out the .strtab section. */
7731 symstrtab = (struct elf_sym_strtab *) bfd_malloc ((symcount + 1)
7732 * sizeof (*symstrtab));
7733 if (symstrtab == NULL)
7735 _bfd_elf_strtab_free (stt);
7739 outbound_syms = (bfd_byte *) bfd_alloc2 (abfd, 1 + symcount,
7740 bed->s->sizeof_sym);
7741 if (outbound_syms == NULL)
7744 _bfd_elf_strtab_free (stt);
7748 symtab_hdr->contents = outbound_syms;
7749 outbound_syms_index = 0;
7751 outbound_shndx = NULL;
7752 outbound_shndx_index = 0;
7754 if (elf_symtab_shndx_list (abfd))
7756 symtab_shndx_hdr = & elf_symtab_shndx_list (abfd)->hdr;
7757 if (symtab_shndx_hdr->sh_name != 0)
7759 amt = (bfd_size_type) (1 + symcount) * sizeof (Elf_External_Sym_Shndx);
7760 outbound_shndx = (bfd_byte *)
7761 bfd_zalloc2 (abfd, 1 + symcount, sizeof (Elf_External_Sym_Shndx));
7762 if (outbound_shndx == NULL)
7765 symtab_shndx_hdr->contents = outbound_shndx;
7766 symtab_shndx_hdr->sh_type = SHT_SYMTAB_SHNDX;
7767 symtab_shndx_hdr->sh_size = amt;
7768 symtab_shndx_hdr->sh_addralign = sizeof (Elf_External_Sym_Shndx);
7769 symtab_shndx_hdr->sh_entsize = sizeof (Elf_External_Sym_Shndx);
7771 /* FIXME: What about any other headers in the list ? */
7774 /* Now generate the data (for "contents"). */
7776 /* Fill in zeroth symbol and swap it out. */
7777 Elf_Internal_Sym sym;
7783 sym.st_shndx = SHN_UNDEF;
7784 sym.st_target_internal = 0;
7785 symstrtab[0].sym = sym;
7786 symstrtab[0].dest_index = outbound_syms_index;
7787 symstrtab[0].destshndx_index = outbound_shndx_index;
7788 outbound_syms_index++;
7789 if (outbound_shndx != NULL)
7790 outbound_shndx_index++;
7794 = (bed->elf_backend_name_local_section_symbols
7795 && bed->elf_backend_name_local_section_symbols (abfd));
7797 syms = bfd_get_outsymbols (abfd);
7798 for (idx = 0; idx < symcount;)
7800 Elf_Internal_Sym sym;
7801 bfd_vma value = syms[idx]->value;
7802 elf_symbol_type *type_ptr;
7803 flagword flags = syms[idx]->flags;
7806 if (!name_local_sections
7807 && (flags & (BSF_SECTION_SYM | BSF_GLOBAL)) == BSF_SECTION_SYM)
7809 /* Local section symbols have no name. */
7810 sym.st_name = (unsigned long) -1;
7814 /* Call _bfd_elf_strtab_offset after _bfd_elf_strtab_finalize
7815 to get the final offset for st_name. */
7817 = (unsigned long) _bfd_elf_strtab_add (stt, syms[idx]->name,
7819 if (sym.st_name == (unsigned long) -1)
7823 type_ptr = elf_symbol_from (abfd, syms[idx]);
7825 if ((flags & BSF_SECTION_SYM) == 0
7826 && bfd_is_com_section (syms[idx]->section))
7828 /* ELF common symbols put the alignment into the `value' field,
7829 and the size into the `size' field. This is backwards from
7830 how BFD handles it, so reverse it here. */
7831 sym.st_size = value;
7832 if (type_ptr == NULL
7833 || type_ptr->internal_elf_sym.st_value == 0)
7834 sym.st_value = value >= 16 ? 16 : (1 << bfd_log2 (value));
7836 sym.st_value = type_ptr->internal_elf_sym.st_value;
7837 sym.st_shndx = _bfd_elf_section_from_bfd_section
7838 (abfd, syms[idx]->section);
7842 asection *sec = syms[idx]->section;
7845 if (sec->output_section)
7847 value += sec->output_offset;
7848 sec = sec->output_section;
7851 /* Don't add in the section vma for relocatable output. */
7852 if (! relocatable_p)
7854 sym.st_value = value;
7855 sym.st_size = type_ptr ? type_ptr->internal_elf_sym.st_size : 0;
7857 if (bfd_is_abs_section (sec)
7859 && type_ptr->internal_elf_sym.st_shndx != 0)
7861 /* This symbol is in a real ELF section which we did
7862 not create as a BFD section. Undo the mapping done
7863 by copy_private_symbol_data. */
7864 shndx = type_ptr->internal_elf_sym.st_shndx;
7868 shndx = elf_onesymtab (abfd);
7871 shndx = elf_dynsymtab (abfd);
7874 shndx = elf_strtab_sec (abfd);
7877 shndx = elf_shstrtab_sec (abfd);
7880 if (elf_symtab_shndx_list (abfd))
7881 shndx = elf_symtab_shndx_list (abfd)->ndx;
7890 shndx = _bfd_elf_section_from_bfd_section (abfd, sec);
7892 if (shndx == SHN_BAD)
7896 /* Writing this would be a hell of a lot easier if
7897 we had some decent documentation on bfd, and
7898 knew what to expect of the library, and what to
7899 demand of applications. For example, it
7900 appears that `objcopy' might not set the
7901 section of a symbol to be a section that is
7902 actually in the output file. */
7903 sec2 = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, sec->name);
7905 shndx = _bfd_elf_section_from_bfd_section (abfd, sec2);
7906 if (shndx == SHN_BAD)
7908 /* xgettext:c-format */
7909 _bfd_error_handler (_("\
7910 Unable to find equivalent output section for symbol '%s' from section '%s'"),
7911 syms[idx]->name ? syms[idx]->name : "<Local sym>",
7913 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_invalid_operation);
7919 sym.st_shndx = shndx;
7922 if ((flags & BSF_THREAD_LOCAL) != 0)
7924 else if ((flags & BSF_GNU_INDIRECT_FUNCTION) != 0)
7925 type = STT_GNU_IFUNC;
7926 else if ((flags & BSF_FUNCTION) != 0)
7928 else if ((flags & BSF_OBJECT) != 0)
7930 else if ((flags & BSF_RELC) != 0)
7932 else if ((flags & BSF_SRELC) != 0)
7937 if (syms[idx]->section->flags & SEC_THREAD_LOCAL)
7940 /* Processor-specific types. */
7941 if (type_ptr != NULL
7942 && bed->elf_backend_get_symbol_type)
7943 type = ((*bed->elf_backend_get_symbol_type)
7944 (&type_ptr->internal_elf_sym, type));
7946 if (flags & BSF_SECTION_SYM)
7948 if (flags & BSF_GLOBAL)
7949 sym.st_info = ELF_ST_INFO (STB_GLOBAL, STT_SECTION);
7951 sym.st_info = ELF_ST_INFO (STB_LOCAL, STT_SECTION);
7953 else if (bfd_is_com_section (syms[idx]->section))
7955 if (type != STT_TLS)
7957 if ((abfd->flags & BFD_CONVERT_ELF_COMMON))
7958 type = ((abfd->flags & BFD_USE_ELF_STT_COMMON)
7959 ? STT_COMMON : STT_OBJECT);
7961 type = ((flags & BSF_ELF_COMMON) != 0
7962 ? STT_COMMON : STT_OBJECT);
7964 sym.st_info = ELF_ST_INFO (STB_GLOBAL, type);
7966 else if (bfd_is_und_section (syms[idx]->section))
7967 sym.st_info = ELF_ST_INFO (((flags & BSF_WEAK)
7971 else if (flags & BSF_FILE)
7972 sym.st_info = ELF_ST_INFO (STB_LOCAL, STT_FILE);
7975 int bind = STB_LOCAL;
7977 if (flags & BSF_LOCAL)
7979 else if (flags & BSF_GNU_UNIQUE)
7980 bind = STB_GNU_UNIQUE;
7981 else if (flags & BSF_WEAK)
7983 else if (flags & BSF_GLOBAL)
7986 sym.st_info = ELF_ST_INFO (bind, type);
7989 if (type_ptr != NULL)
7991 sym.st_other = type_ptr->internal_elf_sym.st_other;
7992 sym.st_target_internal
7993 = type_ptr->internal_elf_sym.st_target_internal;
7998 sym.st_target_internal = 0;
8002 symstrtab[idx].sym = sym;
8003 symstrtab[idx].dest_index = outbound_syms_index;
8004 symstrtab[idx].destshndx_index = outbound_shndx_index;
8006 outbound_syms_index++;
8007 if (outbound_shndx != NULL)
8008 outbound_shndx_index++;
8011 /* Finalize the .strtab section. */
8012 _bfd_elf_strtab_finalize (stt);
8014 /* Swap out the .strtab section. */
8015 for (idx = 0; idx <= symcount; idx++)
8017 struct elf_sym_strtab *elfsym = &symstrtab[idx];
8018 if (elfsym->sym.st_name == (unsigned long) -1)
8019 elfsym->sym.st_name = 0;
8021 elfsym->sym.st_name = _bfd_elf_strtab_offset (stt,
8022 elfsym->sym.st_name);
8023 bed->s->swap_symbol_out (abfd, &elfsym->sym,
8025 + (elfsym->dest_index
8026 * bed->s->sizeof_sym)),
8028 + (elfsym->destshndx_index
8029 * sizeof (Elf_External_Sym_Shndx))));
8034 symstrtab_hdr->sh_size = _bfd_elf_strtab_size (stt);
8035 symstrtab_hdr->sh_type = SHT_STRTAB;
8036 symstrtab_hdr->sh_flags = bed->elf_strtab_flags;
8037 symstrtab_hdr->sh_addr = 0;
8038 symstrtab_hdr->sh_entsize = 0;
8039 symstrtab_hdr->sh_link = 0;
8040 symstrtab_hdr->sh_info = 0;
8041 symstrtab_hdr->sh_addralign = 1;
8046 /* Return the number of bytes required to hold the symtab vector.
8048 Note that we base it on the count plus 1, since we will null terminate
8049 the vector allocated based on this size. However, the ELF symbol table
8050 always has a dummy entry as symbol #0, so it ends up even. */
8053 _bfd_elf_get_symtab_upper_bound (bfd *abfd)
8057 Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr = &elf_tdata (abfd)->symtab_hdr;
8059 symcount = hdr->sh_size / get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->s->sizeof_sym;
8060 symtab_size = (symcount + 1) * (sizeof (asymbol *));
8062 symtab_size -= sizeof (asymbol *);
8068 _bfd_elf_get_dynamic_symtab_upper_bound (bfd *abfd)
8072 Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr = &elf_tdata (abfd)->dynsymtab_hdr;
8074 if (elf_dynsymtab (abfd) == 0)
8076 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_invalid_operation);
8080 symcount = hdr->sh_size / get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->s->sizeof_sym;
8081 symtab_size = (symcount + 1) * (sizeof (asymbol *));
8083 symtab_size -= sizeof (asymbol *);
8089 _bfd_elf_get_reloc_upper_bound (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
8092 return (asect->reloc_count + 1) * sizeof (arelent *);
8095 /* Canonicalize the relocs. */
8098 _bfd_elf_canonicalize_reloc (bfd *abfd,
8105 const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
8107 if (! bed->s->slurp_reloc_table (abfd, section, symbols, FALSE))
8110 tblptr = section->relocation;
8111 for (i = 0; i < section->reloc_count; i++)
8112 *relptr++ = tblptr++;
8116 return section->reloc_count;
8120 _bfd_elf_canonicalize_symtab (bfd *abfd, asymbol **allocation)
8122 const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
8123 long symcount = bed->s->slurp_symbol_table (abfd, allocation, FALSE);
8126 bfd_get_symcount (abfd) = symcount;
8131 _bfd_elf_canonicalize_dynamic_symtab (bfd *abfd,
8132 asymbol **allocation)
8134 const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
8135 long symcount = bed->s->slurp_symbol_table (abfd, allocation, TRUE);
8138 bfd_get_dynamic_symcount (abfd) = symcount;
8142 /* Return the size required for the dynamic reloc entries. Any loadable
8143 section that was actually installed in the BFD, and has type SHT_REL
8144 or SHT_RELA, and uses the dynamic symbol table, is considered to be a
8145 dynamic reloc section. */
8148 _bfd_elf_get_dynamic_reloc_upper_bound (bfd *abfd)
8153 if (elf_dynsymtab (abfd) == 0)
8155 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_invalid_operation);
8159 ret = sizeof (arelent *);
8160 for (s = abfd->sections; s != NULL; s = s->next)
8161 if (elf_section_data (s)->this_hdr.sh_link == elf_dynsymtab (abfd)
8162 && (elf_section_data (s)->this_hdr.sh_type == SHT_REL
8163 || elf_section_data (s)->this_hdr.sh_type == SHT_RELA))
8164 ret += ((s->size / elf_section_data (s)->this_hdr.sh_entsize)
8165 * sizeof (arelent *));
8170 /* Canonicalize the dynamic relocation entries. Note that we return the
8171 dynamic relocations as a single block, although they are actually
8172 associated with particular sections; the interface, which was
8173 designed for SunOS style shared libraries, expects that there is only
8174 one set of dynamic relocs. Any loadable section that was actually
8175 installed in the BFD, and has type SHT_REL or SHT_RELA, and uses the
8176 dynamic symbol table, is considered to be a dynamic reloc section. */
8179 _bfd_elf_canonicalize_dynamic_reloc (bfd *abfd,
8183 bfd_boolean (*slurp_relocs) (bfd *, asection *, asymbol **, bfd_boolean);
8187 if (elf_dynsymtab (abfd) == 0)
8189 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_invalid_operation);
8193 slurp_relocs = get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->s->slurp_reloc_table;
8195 for (s = abfd->sections; s != NULL; s = s->next)
8197 if (elf_section_data (s)->this_hdr.sh_link == elf_dynsymtab (abfd)
8198 && (elf_section_data (s)->this_hdr.sh_type == SHT_REL
8199 || elf_section_data (s)->this_hdr.sh_type == SHT_RELA))
8204 if (! (*slurp_relocs) (abfd, s, syms, TRUE))
8206 count = s->size / elf_section_data (s)->this_hdr.sh_entsize;
8208 for (i = 0; i < count; i++)
8219 /* Read in the version information. */
8222 _bfd_elf_slurp_version_tables (bfd *abfd, bfd_boolean default_imported_symver)
8224 bfd_byte *contents = NULL;
8225 unsigned int freeidx = 0;
8227 if (elf_dynverref (abfd) != 0)
8229 Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr;
8230 Elf_External_Verneed *everneed;
8231 Elf_Internal_Verneed *iverneed;
8233 bfd_byte *contents_end;
8235 hdr = &elf_tdata (abfd)->dynverref_hdr;
8237 if (hdr->sh_info == 0
8238 || hdr->sh_info > hdr->sh_size / sizeof (Elf_External_Verneed))
8240 error_return_bad_verref:
8242 (_("%B: .gnu.version_r invalid entry"), abfd);
8243 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
8244 error_return_verref:
8245 elf_tdata (abfd)->verref = NULL;
8246 elf_tdata (abfd)->cverrefs = 0;
8250 contents = (bfd_byte *) bfd_malloc (hdr->sh_size);
8251 if (contents == NULL)
8252 goto error_return_verref;
8254 if (bfd_seek (abfd, hdr->sh_offset, SEEK_SET) != 0
8255 || bfd_bread (contents, hdr->sh_size, abfd) != hdr->sh_size)
8256 goto error_return_verref;
8258 elf_tdata (abfd)->verref = (Elf_Internal_Verneed *)
8259 bfd_alloc2 (abfd, hdr->sh_info, sizeof (Elf_Internal_Verneed));
8261 if (elf_tdata (abfd)->verref == NULL)
8262 goto error_return_verref;
8264 BFD_ASSERT (sizeof (Elf_External_Verneed)
8265 == sizeof (Elf_External_Vernaux));
8266 contents_end = contents + hdr->sh_size - sizeof (Elf_External_Verneed);
8267 everneed = (Elf_External_Verneed *) contents;
8268 iverneed = elf_tdata (abfd)->verref;
8269 for (i = 0; i < hdr->sh_info; i++, iverneed++)
8271 Elf_External_Vernaux *evernaux;
8272 Elf_Internal_Vernaux *ivernaux;
8275 _bfd_elf_swap_verneed_in (abfd, everneed, iverneed);
8277 iverneed->vn_bfd = abfd;
8279 iverneed->vn_filename =
8280 bfd_elf_string_from_elf_section (abfd, hdr->sh_link,
8282 if (iverneed->vn_filename == NULL)
8283 goto error_return_bad_verref;
8285 if (iverneed->vn_cnt == 0)
8286 iverneed->vn_auxptr = NULL;
8289 iverneed->vn_auxptr = (struct elf_internal_vernaux *)
8290 bfd_alloc2 (abfd, iverneed->vn_cnt,
8291 sizeof (Elf_Internal_Vernaux));
8292 if (iverneed->vn_auxptr == NULL)
8293 goto error_return_verref;
8296 if (iverneed->vn_aux
8297 > (size_t) (contents_end - (bfd_byte *) everneed))
8298 goto error_return_bad_verref;
8300 evernaux = ((Elf_External_Vernaux *)
8301 ((bfd_byte *) everneed + iverneed->vn_aux));
8302 ivernaux = iverneed->vn_auxptr;
8303 for (j = 0; j < iverneed->vn_cnt; j++, ivernaux++)
8305 _bfd_elf_swap_vernaux_in (abfd, evernaux, ivernaux);
8307 ivernaux->vna_nodename =
8308 bfd_elf_string_from_elf_section (abfd, hdr->sh_link,
8309 ivernaux->vna_name);
8310 if (ivernaux->vna_nodename == NULL)
8311 goto error_return_bad_verref;
8313 if (ivernaux->vna_other > freeidx)
8314 freeidx = ivernaux->vna_other;
8316 ivernaux->vna_nextptr = NULL;
8317 if (ivernaux->vna_next == 0)
8319 iverneed->vn_cnt = j + 1;
8322 if (j + 1 < iverneed->vn_cnt)
8323 ivernaux->vna_nextptr = ivernaux + 1;
8325 if (ivernaux->vna_next
8326 > (size_t) (contents_end - (bfd_byte *) evernaux))
8327 goto error_return_bad_verref;
8329 evernaux = ((Elf_External_Vernaux *)
8330 ((bfd_byte *) evernaux + ivernaux->vna_next));
8333 iverneed->vn_nextref = NULL;
8334 if (iverneed->vn_next == 0)
8336 if (i + 1 < hdr->sh_info)
8337 iverneed->vn_nextref = iverneed + 1;
8339 if (iverneed->vn_next
8340 > (size_t) (contents_end - (bfd_byte *) everneed))
8341 goto error_return_bad_verref;
8343 everneed = ((Elf_External_Verneed *)
8344 ((bfd_byte *) everneed + iverneed->vn_next));
8346 elf_tdata (abfd)->cverrefs = i;
8352 if (elf_dynverdef (abfd) != 0)
8354 Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr;
8355 Elf_External_Verdef *everdef;
8356 Elf_Internal_Verdef *iverdef;
8357 Elf_Internal_Verdef *iverdefarr;
8358 Elf_Internal_Verdef iverdefmem;
8360 unsigned int maxidx;
8361 bfd_byte *contents_end_def, *contents_end_aux;
8363 hdr = &elf_tdata (abfd)->dynverdef_hdr;
8365 if (hdr->sh_info == 0 || hdr->sh_size < sizeof (Elf_External_Verdef))
8367 error_return_bad_verdef:
8369 (_("%B: .gnu.version_d invalid entry"), abfd);
8370 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
8371 error_return_verdef:
8372 elf_tdata (abfd)->verdef = NULL;
8373 elf_tdata (abfd)->cverdefs = 0;
8377 contents = (bfd_byte *) bfd_malloc (hdr->sh_size);
8378 if (contents == NULL)
8379 goto error_return_verdef;
8380 if (bfd_seek (abfd, hdr->sh_offset, SEEK_SET) != 0
8381 || bfd_bread (contents, hdr->sh_size, abfd) != hdr->sh_size)
8382 goto error_return_verdef;
8384 BFD_ASSERT (sizeof (Elf_External_Verdef)
8385 >= sizeof (Elf_External_Verdaux));
8386 contents_end_def = contents + hdr->sh_size
8387 - sizeof (Elf_External_Verdef);
8388 contents_end_aux = contents + hdr->sh_size
8389 - sizeof (Elf_External_Verdaux);
8391 /* We know the number of entries in the section but not the maximum
8392 index. Therefore we have to run through all entries and find
8394 everdef = (Elf_External_Verdef *) contents;
8396 for (i = 0; i < hdr->sh_info; ++i)
8398 _bfd_elf_swap_verdef_in (abfd, everdef, &iverdefmem);
8400 if ((iverdefmem.vd_ndx & ((unsigned) VERSYM_VERSION)) == 0)
8401 goto error_return_bad_verdef;
8402 if ((iverdefmem.vd_ndx & ((unsigned) VERSYM_VERSION)) > maxidx)
8403 maxidx = iverdefmem.vd_ndx & ((unsigned) VERSYM_VERSION);
8405 if (iverdefmem.vd_next == 0)
8408 if (iverdefmem.vd_next
8409 > (size_t) (contents_end_def - (bfd_byte *) everdef))
8410 goto error_return_bad_verdef;
8412 everdef = ((Elf_External_Verdef *)
8413 ((bfd_byte *) everdef + iverdefmem.vd_next));
8416 if (default_imported_symver)
8418 if (freeidx > maxidx)
8424 elf_tdata (abfd)->verdef = (Elf_Internal_Verdef *)
8425 bfd_zalloc2 (abfd, maxidx, sizeof (Elf_Internal_Verdef));
8426 if (elf_tdata (abfd)->verdef == NULL)
8427 goto error_return_verdef;
8429 elf_tdata (abfd)->cverdefs = maxidx;
8431 everdef = (Elf_External_Verdef *) contents;
8432 iverdefarr = elf_tdata (abfd)->verdef;
8433 for (i = 0; i < hdr->sh_info; i++)
8435 Elf_External_Verdaux *everdaux;
8436 Elf_Internal_Verdaux *iverdaux;
8439 _bfd_elf_swap_verdef_in (abfd, everdef, &iverdefmem);
8441 if ((iverdefmem.vd_ndx & VERSYM_VERSION) == 0)
8442 goto error_return_bad_verdef;
8444 iverdef = &iverdefarr[(iverdefmem.vd_ndx & VERSYM_VERSION) - 1];
8445 memcpy (iverdef, &iverdefmem, offsetof (Elf_Internal_Verdef, vd_bfd));
8447 iverdef->vd_bfd = abfd;
8449 if (iverdef->vd_cnt == 0)
8450 iverdef->vd_auxptr = NULL;
8453 iverdef->vd_auxptr = (struct elf_internal_verdaux *)
8454 bfd_alloc2 (abfd, iverdef->vd_cnt,
8455 sizeof (Elf_Internal_Verdaux));
8456 if (iverdef->vd_auxptr == NULL)
8457 goto error_return_verdef;
8461 > (size_t) (contents_end_aux - (bfd_byte *) everdef))
8462 goto error_return_bad_verdef;
8464 everdaux = ((Elf_External_Verdaux *)
8465 ((bfd_byte *) everdef + iverdef->vd_aux));
8466 iverdaux = iverdef->vd_auxptr;
8467 for (j = 0; j < iverdef->vd_cnt; j++, iverdaux++)
8469 _bfd_elf_swap_verdaux_in (abfd, everdaux, iverdaux);
8471 iverdaux->vda_nodename =
8472 bfd_elf_string_from_elf_section (abfd, hdr->sh_link,
8473 iverdaux->vda_name);
8474 if (iverdaux->vda_nodename == NULL)
8475 goto error_return_bad_verdef;
8477 iverdaux->vda_nextptr = NULL;
8478 if (iverdaux->vda_next == 0)
8480 iverdef->vd_cnt = j + 1;
8483 if (j + 1 < iverdef->vd_cnt)
8484 iverdaux->vda_nextptr = iverdaux + 1;
8486 if (iverdaux->vda_next
8487 > (size_t) (contents_end_aux - (bfd_byte *) everdaux))
8488 goto error_return_bad_verdef;
8490 everdaux = ((Elf_External_Verdaux *)
8491 ((bfd_byte *) everdaux + iverdaux->vda_next));
8494 iverdef->vd_nodename = NULL;
8495 if (iverdef->vd_cnt)
8496 iverdef->vd_nodename = iverdef->vd_auxptr->vda_nodename;
8498 iverdef->vd_nextdef = NULL;
8499 if (iverdef->vd_next == 0)
8501 if ((size_t) (iverdef - iverdefarr) + 1 < maxidx)
8502 iverdef->vd_nextdef = iverdef + 1;
8504 everdef = ((Elf_External_Verdef *)
8505 ((bfd_byte *) everdef + iverdef->vd_next));
8511 else if (default_imported_symver)
8518 elf_tdata (abfd)->verdef = (Elf_Internal_Verdef *)
8519 bfd_zalloc2 (abfd, freeidx, sizeof (Elf_Internal_Verdef));
8520 if (elf_tdata (abfd)->verdef == NULL)
8523 elf_tdata (abfd)->cverdefs = freeidx;
8526 /* Create a default version based on the soname. */
8527 if (default_imported_symver)
8529 Elf_Internal_Verdef *iverdef;
8530 Elf_Internal_Verdaux *iverdaux;
8532 iverdef = &elf_tdata (abfd)->verdef[freeidx - 1];
8534 iverdef->vd_version = VER_DEF_CURRENT;
8535 iverdef->vd_flags = 0;
8536 iverdef->vd_ndx = freeidx;
8537 iverdef->vd_cnt = 1;
8539 iverdef->vd_bfd = abfd;
8541 iverdef->vd_nodename = bfd_elf_get_dt_soname (abfd);
8542 if (iverdef->vd_nodename == NULL)
8543 goto error_return_verdef;
8544 iverdef->vd_nextdef = NULL;
8545 iverdef->vd_auxptr = ((struct elf_internal_verdaux *)
8546 bfd_zalloc (abfd, sizeof (Elf_Internal_Verdaux)));
8547 if (iverdef->vd_auxptr == NULL)
8548 goto error_return_verdef;
8550 iverdaux = iverdef->vd_auxptr;
8551 iverdaux->vda_nodename = iverdef->vd_nodename;
8557 if (contents != NULL)
8563 _bfd_elf_make_empty_symbol (bfd *abfd)
8565 elf_symbol_type *newsym;
8567 newsym = (elf_symbol_type *) bfd_zalloc (abfd, sizeof * newsym);
8570 newsym->symbol.the_bfd = abfd;
8571 return &newsym->symbol;
8575 _bfd_elf_get_symbol_info (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
8579 bfd_symbol_info (symbol, ret);
8582 /* Return whether a symbol name implies a local symbol. Most targets
8583 use this function for the is_local_label_name entry point, but some
8587 _bfd_elf_is_local_label_name (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
8590 /* Normal local symbols start with ``.L''. */
8591 if (name[0] == '.' && name[1] == 'L')
8594 /* At least some SVR4 compilers (e.g., UnixWare 2.1 cc) generate
8595 DWARF debugging symbols starting with ``..''. */
8596 if (name[0] == '.' && name[1] == '.')
8599 /* gcc will sometimes generate symbols beginning with ``_.L_'' when
8600 emitting DWARF debugging output. I suspect this is actually a
8601 small bug in gcc (it calls ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL when it should call
8602 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL, and this causes the leading
8603 underscore to be emitted on some ELF targets). For ease of use,
8604 we treat such symbols as local. */
8605 if (name[0] == '_' && name[1] == '.' && name[2] == 'L' && name[3] == '_')
8608 /* Treat assembler generated fake symbols, dollar local labels and
8609 forward-backward labels (aka local labels) as locals.
8610 These labels have the form:
8612 L0^A.* (fake symbols)
8614 [.]?L[0123456789]+{^A|^B}[0123456789]* (local labels)
8616 Versions which start with .L will have already been matched above,
8617 so we only need to match the rest. */
8618 if (name[0] == 'L' && ISDIGIT (name[1]))
8620 bfd_boolean ret = FALSE;
8624 for (p = name + 2; (c = *p); p++)
8626 if (c == 1 || c == 2)
8628 if (c == 1 && p == name + 2)
8629 /* A fake symbol. */
8632 /* FIXME: We are being paranoid here and treating symbols like
8633 L0^Bfoo as if there were non-local, on the grounds that the
8634 assembler will never generate them. But can any symbol
8635 containing an ASCII value in the range 1-31 ever be anything
8636 other than some kind of local ? */
8653 _bfd_elf_get_lineno (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
8654 asymbol *symbol ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
8661 _bfd_elf_set_arch_mach (bfd *abfd,
8662 enum bfd_architecture arch,
8663 unsigned long machine)
8665 /* If this isn't the right architecture for this backend, and this
8666 isn't the generic backend, fail. */
8667 if (arch != get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->arch
8668 && arch != bfd_arch_unknown
8669 && get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->arch != bfd_arch_unknown)
8672 return bfd_default_set_arch_mach (abfd, arch, machine);
8675 /* Find the nearest line to a particular section and offset,
8676 for error reporting. */
8679 _bfd_elf_find_nearest_line (bfd *abfd,
8683 const char **filename_ptr,
8684 const char **functionname_ptr,
8685 unsigned int *line_ptr,
8686 unsigned int *discriminator_ptr)
8690 if (_bfd_dwarf2_find_nearest_line (abfd, symbols, NULL, section, offset,
8691 filename_ptr, functionname_ptr,
8692 line_ptr, discriminator_ptr,
8693 dwarf_debug_sections, 0,
8694 &elf_tdata (abfd)->dwarf2_find_line_info)
8695 || _bfd_dwarf1_find_nearest_line (abfd, symbols, section, offset,
8696 filename_ptr, functionname_ptr,
8699 if (!*functionname_ptr)
8700 _bfd_elf_find_function (abfd, symbols, section, offset,
8701 *filename_ptr ? NULL : filename_ptr,
8706 if (! _bfd_stab_section_find_nearest_line (abfd, symbols, section, offset,
8707 &found, filename_ptr,
8708 functionname_ptr, line_ptr,
8709 &elf_tdata (abfd)->line_info))
8711 if (found && (*functionname_ptr || *line_ptr))
8714 if (symbols == NULL)
8717 if (! _bfd_elf_find_function (abfd, symbols, section, offset,
8718 filename_ptr, functionname_ptr))
8725 /* Find the line for a symbol. */
8728 _bfd_elf_find_line (bfd *abfd, asymbol **symbols, asymbol *symbol,
8729 const char **filename_ptr, unsigned int *line_ptr)
8731 return _bfd_dwarf2_find_nearest_line (abfd, symbols, symbol, NULL, 0,
8732 filename_ptr, NULL, line_ptr, NULL,
8733 dwarf_debug_sections, 0,
8734 &elf_tdata (abfd)->dwarf2_find_line_info);
8737 /* After a call to bfd_find_nearest_line, successive calls to
8738 bfd_find_inliner_info can be used to get source information about
8739 each level of function inlining that terminated at the address
8740 passed to bfd_find_nearest_line. Currently this is only supported
8741 for DWARF2 with appropriate DWARF3 extensions. */
8744 _bfd_elf_find_inliner_info (bfd *abfd,
8745 const char **filename_ptr,
8746 const char **functionname_ptr,
8747 unsigned int *line_ptr)
8750 found = _bfd_dwarf2_find_inliner_info (abfd, filename_ptr,
8751 functionname_ptr, line_ptr,
8752 & elf_tdata (abfd)->dwarf2_find_line_info);
8757 _bfd_elf_sizeof_headers (bfd *abfd, struct bfd_link_info *info)
8759 const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
8760 int ret = bed->s->sizeof_ehdr;
8762 if (!bfd_link_relocatable (info))
8764 bfd_size_type phdr_size = elf_program_header_size (abfd);
8766 if (phdr_size == (bfd_size_type) -1)
8768 struct elf_segment_map *m;
8771 for (m = elf_seg_map (abfd); m != NULL; m = m->next)
8772 phdr_size += bed->s->sizeof_phdr;
8775 phdr_size = get_program_header_size (abfd, info);
8778 elf_program_header_size (abfd) = phdr_size;
8786 _bfd_elf_set_section_contents (bfd *abfd,
8788 const void *location,
8790 bfd_size_type count)
8792 Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr;
8795 if (! abfd->output_has_begun
8796 && ! _bfd_elf_compute_section_file_positions (abfd, NULL))
8802 hdr = &elf_section_data (section)->this_hdr;
8803 if (hdr->sh_offset == (file_ptr) -1)
8805 /* We must compress this section. Write output to the buffer. */
8806 unsigned char *contents = hdr->contents;
8807 if ((offset + count) > hdr->sh_size
8808 || (section->flags & SEC_ELF_COMPRESS) == 0
8809 || contents == NULL)
8811 memcpy (contents + offset, location, count);
8814 pos = hdr->sh_offset + offset;
8815 if (bfd_seek (abfd, pos, SEEK_SET) != 0
8816 || bfd_bwrite (location, count, abfd) != count)
8823 _bfd_elf_no_info_to_howto (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
8824 arelent *cache_ptr ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
8825 Elf_Internal_Rela *dst ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
8830 /* Try to convert a non-ELF reloc into an ELF one. */
8833 _bfd_elf_validate_reloc (bfd *abfd, arelent *areloc)
8835 /* Check whether we really have an ELF howto. */
8837 if ((*areloc->sym_ptr_ptr)->the_bfd->xvec != abfd->xvec)
8839 bfd_reloc_code_real_type code;
8840 reloc_howto_type *howto;
8842 /* Alien reloc: Try to determine its type to replace it with an
8843 equivalent ELF reloc. */
8845 if (areloc->howto->pc_relative)
8847 switch (areloc->howto->bitsize)
8850 code = BFD_RELOC_8_PCREL;
8853 code = BFD_RELOC_12_PCREL;
8856 code = BFD_RELOC_16_PCREL;
8859 code = BFD_RELOC_24_PCREL;
8862 code = BFD_RELOC_32_PCREL;
8865 code = BFD_RELOC_64_PCREL;
8871 howto = bfd_reloc_type_lookup (abfd, code);
8873 if (areloc->howto->pcrel_offset != howto->pcrel_offset)
8875 if (howto->pcrel_offset)
8876 areloc->addend += areloc->address;
8878 areloc->addend -= areloc->address; /* addend is unsigned!! */
8883 switch (areloc->howto->bitsize)
8889 code = BFD_RELOC_14;
8892 code = BFD_RELOC_16;
8895 code = BFD_RELOC_26;
8898 code = BFD_RELOC_32;
8901 code = BFD_RELOC_64;
8907 howto = bfd_reloc_type_lookup (abfd, code);
8911 areloc->howto = howto;
8920 /* xgettext:c-format */
8921 (_("%B: unsupported relocation type %s"),
8922 abfd, areloc->howto->name);
8923 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
8928 _bfd_elf_close_and_cleanup (bfd *abfd)
8930 struct elf_obj_tdata *tdata = elf_tdata (abfd);
8931 if (bfd_get_format (abfd) == bfd_object && tdata != NULL)
8933 if (elf_tdata (abfd)->o != NULL && elf_shstrtab (abfd) != NULL)
8934 _bfd_elf_strtab_free (elf_shstrtab (abfd));
8935 _bfd_dwarf2_cleanup_debug_info (abfd, &tdata->dwarf2_find_line_info);
8938 return _bfd_generic_close_and_cleanup (abfd);
8941 /* For Rel targets, we encode meaningful data for BFD_RELOC_VTABLE_ENTRY
8942 in the relocation's offset. Thus we cannot allow any sort of sanity
8943 range-checking to interfere. There is nothing else to do in processing
8946 bfd_reloc_status_type
8947 _bfd_elf_rel_vtable_reloc_fn
8948 (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, arelent *re ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
8949 struct bfd_symbol *symbol ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
8950 void *data ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, asection *is ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
8951 bfd *obfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, char **errmsg ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
8953 return bfd_reloc_ok;
8956 /* Elf core file support. Much of this only works on native
8957 toolchains, since we rely on knowing the
8958 machine-dependent procfs structure in order to pick
8959 out details about the corefile. */
8961 #ifdef HAVE_SYS_PROCFS_H
8962 /* Needed for new procfs interface on sparc-solaris. */
8963 # define _STRUCTURED_PROC 1
8964 # include <sys/procfs.h>
8967 /* Return a PID that identifies a "thread" for threaded cores, or the
8968 PID of the main process for non-threaded cores. */
8971 elfcore_make_pid (bfd *abfd)
8975 pid = elf_tdata (abfd)->core->lwpid;
8977 pid = elf_tdata (abfd)->core->pid;
8982 /* If there isn't a section called NAME, make one, using
8983 data from SECT. Note, this function will generate a
8984 reference to NAME, so you shouldn't deallocate or
8988 elfcore_maybe_make_sect (bfd *abfd, char *name, asection *sect)
8992 if (bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, name) != NULL)
8995 sect2 = bfd_make_section_with_flags (abfd, name, sect->flags);
8999 sect2->size = sect->size;
9000 sect2->filepos = sect->filepos;
9001 sect2->alignment_power = sect->alignment_power;
9005 /* Create a pseudosection containing SIZE bytes at FILEPOS. This
9006 actually creates up to two pseudosections:
9007 - For the single-threaded case, a section named NAME, unless
9008 such a section already exists.
9009 - For the multi-threaded case, a section named "NAME/PID", where
9010 PID is elfcore_make_pid (abfd).
9011 Both pseudosections have identical contents. */
9013 _bfd_elfcore_make_pseudosection (bfd *abfd,
9019 char *threaded_name;
9023 /* Build the section name. */
9025 sprintf (buf, "%s/%d", name, elfcore_make_pid (abfd));
9026 len = strlen (buf) + 1;
9027 threaded_name = (char *) bfd_alloc (abfd, len);
9028 if (threaded_name == NULL)
9030 memcpy (threaded_name, buf, len);
9032 sect = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, threaded_name,
9037 sect->filepos = filepos;
9038 sect->alignment_power = 2;
9040 return elfcore_maybe_make_sect (abfd, name, sect);
9043 /* prstatus_t exists on:
9045 linux 2.[01] + glibc
9049 #if defined (HAVE_PRSTATUS_T)
9052 elfcore_grok_prstatus (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9057 if (note->descsz == sizeof (prstatus_t))
9061 size = sizeof (prstat.pr_reg);
9062 offset = offsetof (prstatus_t, pr_reg);
9063 memcpy (&prstat, note->descdata, sizeof (prstat));
9065 /* Do not overwrite the core signal if it
9066 has already been set by another thread. */
9067 if (elf_tdata (abfd)->core->signal == 0)
9068 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->signal = prstat.pr_cursig;
9069 if (elf_tdata (abfd)->core->pid == 0)
9070 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->pid = prstat.pr_pid;
9072 /* pr_who exists on:
9075 pr_who doesn't exist on:
9078 #if defined (HAVE_PRSTATUS_T_PR_WHO)
9079 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->lwpid = prstat.pr_who;
9081 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->lwpid = prstat.pr_pid;
9084 #if defined (HAVE_PRSTATUS32_T)
9085 else if (note->descsz == sizeof (prstatus32_t))
9087 /* 64-bit host, 32-bit corefile */
9088 prstatus32_t prstat;
9090 size = sizeof (prstat.pr_reg);
9091 offset = offsetof (prstatus32_t, pr_reg);
9092 memcpy (&prstat, note->descdata, sizeof (prstat));
9094 /* Do not overwrite the core signal if it
9095 has already been set by another thread. */
9096 if (elf_tdata (abfd)->core->signal == 0)
9097 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->signal = prstat.pr_cursig;
9098 if (elf_tdata (abfd)->core->pid == 0)
9099 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->pid = prstat.pr_pid;
9101 /* pr_who exists on:
9104 pr_who doesn't exist on:
9107 #if defined (HAVE_PRSTATUS32_T_PR_WHO)
9108 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->lwpid = prstat.pr_who;
9110 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->lwpid = prstat.pr_pid;
9113 #endif /* HAVE_PRSTATUS32_T */
9116 /* Fail - we don't know how to handle any other
9117 note size (ie. data object type). */
9121 /* Make a ".reg/999" section and a ".reg" section. */
9122 return _bfd_elfcore_make_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg",
9123 size, note->descpos + offset);
9125 #endif /* defined (HAVE_PRSTATUS_T) */
9127 /* Create a pseudosection containing the exact contents of NOTE. */
9129 elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (bfd *abfd,
9131 Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9133 return _bfd_elfcore_make_pseudosection (abfd, name,
9134 note->descsz, note->descpos);
9137 /* There isn't a consistent prfpregset_t across platforms,
9138 but it doesn't matter, because we don't have to pick this
9139 data structure apart. */
9142 elfcore_grok_prfpreg (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9144 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg2", note);
9147 /* Linux dumps the Intel SSE regs in a note named "LINUX" with a note
9148 type of NT_PRXFPREG. Just include the whole note's contents
9152 elfcore_grok_prxfpreg (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9154 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-xfp", note);
9157 /* Linux dumps the Intel XSAVE extended state in a note named "LINUX"
9158 with a note type of NT_X86_XSTATE. Just include the whole note's
9159 contents literally. */
9162 elfcore_grok_xstatereg (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9164 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-xstate", note);
9168 elfcore_grok_ppc_vmx (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9170 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-ppc-vmx", note);
9174 elfcore_grok_ppc_vsx (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9176 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-ppc-vsx", note);
9180 elfcore_grok_s390_high_gprs (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9182 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-s390-high-gprs", note);
9186 elfcore_grok_s390_timer (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9188 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-s390-timer", note);
9192 elfcore_grok_s390_todcmp (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9194 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-s390-todcmp", note);
9198 elfcore_grok_s390_todpreg (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9200 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-s390-todpreg", note);
9204 elfcore_grok_s390_ctrs (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9206 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-s390-ctrs", note);
9210 elfcore_grok_s390_prefix (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9212 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-s390-prefix", note);
9216 elfcore_grok_s390_last_break (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9218 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-s390-last-break", note);
9222 elfcore_grok_s390_system_call (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9224 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-s390-system-call", note);
9228 elfcore_grok_s390_tdb (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9230 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-s390-tdb", note);
9234 elfcore_grok_s390_vxrs_low (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9236 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-s390-vxrs-low", note);
9240 elfcore_grok_s390_vxrs_high (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9242 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-s390-vxrs-high", note);
9246 elfcore_grok_s390_gs_cb (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9248 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-s390-gs-cb", note);
9252 elfcore_grok_s390_gs_bc (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9254 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-s390-gs-bc", note);
9258 elfcore_grok_arm_vfp (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9260 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-arm-vfp", note);
9264 elfcore_grok_aarch_tls (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9266 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-aarch-tls", note);
9270 elfcore_grok_aarch_hw_break (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9272 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-aarch-hw-break", note);
9276 elfcore_grok_aarch_hw_watch (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9278 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-aarch-hw-watch", note);
9281 #if defined (HAVE_PRPSINFO_T)
9282 typedef prpsinfo_t elfcore_psinfo_t;
9283 #if defined (HAVE_PRPSINFO32_T) /* Sparc64 cross Sparc32 */
9284 typedef prpsinfo32_t elfcore_psinfo32_t;
9288 #if defined (HAVE_PSINFO_T)
9289 typedef psinfo_t elfcore_psinfo_t;
9290 #if defined (HAVE_PSINFO32_T) /* Sparc64 cross Sparc32 */
9291 typedef psinfo32_t elfcore_psinfo32_t;
9295 /* return a malloc'ed copy of a string at START which is at
9296 most MAX bytes long, possibly without a terminating '\0'.
9297 the copy will always have a terminating '\0'. */
9300 _bfd_elfcore_strndup (bfd *abfd, char *start, size_t max)
9303 char *end = (char *) memchr (start, '\0', max);
9311 dups = (char *) bfd_alloc (abfd, len + 1);
9315 memcpy (dups, start, len);
9321 #if defined (HAVE_PRPSINFO_T) || defined (HAVE_PSINFO_T)
9323 elfcore_grok_psinfo (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9325 if (note->descsz == sizeof (elfcore_psinfo_t))
9327 elfcore_psinfo_t psinfo;
9329 memcpy (&psinfo, note->descdata, sizeof (psinfo));
9331 #if defined (HAVE_PSINFO_T_PR_PID) || defined (HAVE_PRPSINFO_T_PR_PID)
9332 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->pid = psinfo.pr_pid;
9334 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->program
9335 = _bfd_elfcore_strndup (abfd, psinfo.pr_fname,
9336 sizeof (psinfo.pr_fname));
9338 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->command
9339 = _bfd_elfcore_strndup (abfd, psinfo.pr_psargs,
9340 sizeof (psinfo.pr_psargs));
9342 #if defined (HAVE_PRPSINFO32_T) || defined (HAVE_PSINFO32_T)
9343 else if (note->descsz == sizeof (elfcore_psinfo32_t))
9345 /* 64-bit host, 32-bit corefile */
9346 elfcore_psinfo32_t psinfo;
9348 memcpy (&psinfo, note->descdata, sizeof (psinfo));
9350 #if defined (HAVE_PSINFO32_T_PR_PID) || defined (HAVE_PRPSINFO32_T_PR_PID)
9351 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->pid = psinfo.pr_pid;
9353 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->program
9354 = _bfd_elfcore_strndup (abfd, psinfo.pr_fname,
9355 sizeof (psinfo.pr_fname));
9357 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->command
9358 = _bfd_elfcore_strndup (abfd, psinfo.pr_psargs,
9359 sizeof (psinfo.pr_psargs));
9365 /* Fail - we don't know how to handle any other
9366 note size (ie. data object type). */
9370 /* Note that for some reason, a spurious space is tacked
9371 onto the end of the args in some (at least one anyway)
9372 implementations, so strip it off if it exists. */
9375 char *command = elf_tdata (abfd)->core->command;
9376 int n = strlen (command);
9378 if (0 < n && command[n - 1] == ' ')
9379 command[n - 1] = '\0';
9384 #endif /* defined (HAVE_PRPSINFO_T) || defined (HAVE_PSINFO_T) */
9386 #if defined (HAVE_PSTATUS_T)
9388 elfcore_grok_pstatus (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9390 if (note->descsz == sizeof (pstatus_t)
9391 #if defined (HAVE_PXSTATUS_T)
9392 || note->descsz == sizeof (pxstatus_t)
9398 memcpy (&pstat, note->descdata, sizeof (pstat));
9400 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->pid = pstat.pr_pid;
9402 #if defined (HAVE_PSTATUS32_T)
9403 else if (note->descsz == sizeof (pstatus32_t))
9405 /* 64-bit host, 32-bit corefile */
9408 memcpy (&pstat, note->descdata, sizeof (pstat));
9410 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->pid = pstat.pr_pid;
9413 /* Could grab some more details from the "representative"
9414 lwpstatus_t in pstat.pr_lwp, but we'll catch it all in an
9415 NT_LWPSTATUS note, presumably. */
9419 #endif /* defined (HAVE_PSTATUS_T) */
9421 #if defined (HAVE_LWPSTATUS_T)
9423 elfcore_grok_lwpstatus (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9425 lwpstatus_t lwpstat;
9431 if (note->descsz != sizeof (lwpstat)
9432 #if defined (HAVE_LWPXSTATUS_T)
9433 && note->descsz != sizeof (lwpxstatus_t)
9438 memcpy (&lwpstat, note->descdata, sizeof (lwpstat));
9440 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->lwpid = lwpstat.pr_lwpid;
9441 /* Do not overwrite the core signal if it has already been set by
9443 if (elf_tdata (abfd)->core->signal == 0)
9444 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->signal = lwpstat.pr_cursig;
9446 /* Make a ".reg/999" section. */
9448 sprintf (buf, ".reg/%d", elfcore_make_pid (abfd));
9449 len = strlen (buf) + 1;
9450 name = bfd_alloc (abfd, len);
9453 memcpy (name, buf, len);
9455 sect = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, name, SEC_HAS_CONTENTS);
9459 #if defined (HAVE_LWPSTATUS_T_PR_CONTEXT)
9460 sect->size = sizeof (lwpstat.pr_context.uc_mcontext.gregs);
9461 sect->filepos = note->descpos
9462 + offsetof (lwpstatus_t, pr_context.uc_mcontext.gregs);
9465 #if defined (HAVE_LWPSTATUS_T_PR_REG)
9466 sect->size = sizeof (lwpstat.pr_reg);
9467 sect->filepos = note->descpos + offsetof (lwpstatus_t, pr_reg);
9470 sect->alignment_power = 2;
9472 if (!elfcore_maybe_make_sect (abfd, ".reg", sect))
9475 /* Make a ".reg2/999" section */
9477 sprintf (buf, ".reg2/%d", elfcore_make_pid (abfd));
9478 len = strlen (buf) + 1;
9479 name = bfd_alloc (abfd, len);
9482 memcpy (name, buf, len);
9484 sect = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, name, SEC_HAS_CONTENTS);
9488 #if defined (HAVE_LWPSTATUS_T_PR_CONTEXT)
9489 sect->size = sizeof (lwpstat.pr_context.uc_mcontext.fpregs);
9490 sect->filepos = note->descpos
9491 + offsetof (lwpstatus_t, pr_context.uc_mcontext.fpregs);
9494 #if defined (HAVE_LWPSTATUS_T_PR_FPREG)
9495 sect->size = sizeof (lwpstat.pr_fpreg);
9496 sect->filepos = note->descpos + offsetof (lwpstatus_t, pr_fpreg);
9499 sect->alignment_power = 2;
9501 return elfcore_maybe_make_sect (abfd, ".reg2", sect);
9503 #endif /* defined (HAVE_LWPSTATUS_T) */
9506 elfcore_grok_win32pstatus (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9513 int is_active_thread;
9516 if (note->descsz < 728)
9519 if (! CONST_STRNEQ (note->namedata, "win32"))
9522 type = bfd_get_32 (abfd, note->descdata);
9526 case 1 /* NOTE_INFO_PROCESS */:
9527 /* FIXME: need to add ->core->command. */
9528 /* process_info.pid */
9529 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->pid = bfd_get_32 (abfd, note->descdata + 8);
9530 /* process_info.signal */
9531 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->signal = bfd_get_32 (abfd, note->descdata + 12);
9534 case 2 /* NOTE_INFO_THREAD */:
9535 /* Make a ".reg/999" section. */
9536 /* thread_info.tid */
9537 sprintf (buf, ".reg/%ld", (long) bfd_get_32 (abfd, note->descdata + 8));
9539 len = strlen (buf) + 1;
9540 name = (char *) bfd_alloc (abfd, len);
9544 memcpy (name, buf, len);
9546 sect = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, name, SEC_HAS_CONTENTS);
9550 /* sizeof (thread_info.thread_context) */
9552 /* offsetof (thread_info.thread_context) */
9553 sect->filepos = note->descpos + 12;
9554 sect->alignment_power = 2;
9556 /* thread_info.is_active_thread */
9557 is_active_thread = bfd_get_32 (abfd, note->descdata + 8);
9559 if (is_active_thread)
9560 if (! elfcore_maybe_make_sect (abfd, ".reg", sect))
9564 case 3 /* NOTE_INFO_MODULE */:
9565 /* Make a ".module/xxxxxxxx" section. */
9566 /* module_info.base_address */
9567 base_addr = bfd_get_32 (abfd, note->descdata + 4);
9568 sprintf (buf, ".module/%08lx", (unsigned long) base_addr);
9570 len = strlen (buf) + 1;
9571 name = (char *) bfd_alloc (abfd, len);
9575 memcpy (name, buf, len);
9577 sect = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, name, SEC_HAS_CONTENTS);
9582 sect->size = note->descsz;
9583 sect->filepos = note->descpos;
9584 sect->alignment_power = 2;
9595 elfcore_grok_note (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9597 const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
9605 if (bed->elf_backend_grok_prstatus)
9606 if ((*bed->elf_backend_grok_prstatus) (abfd, note))
9608 #if defined (HAVE_PRSTATUS_T)
9609 return elfcore_grok_prstatus (abfd, note);
9614 #if defined (HAVE_PSTATUS_T)
9616 return elfcore_grok_pstatus (abfd, note);
9619 #if defined (HAVE_LWPSTATUS_T)
9621 return elfcore_grok_lwpstatus (abfd, note);
9624 case NT_FPREGSET: /* FIXME: rename to NT_PRFPREG */
9625 return elfcore_grok_prfpreg (abfd, note);
9627 case NT_WIN32PSTATUS:
9628 return elfcore_grok_win32pstatus (abfd, note);
9630 case NT_PRXFPREG: /* Linux SSE extension */
9631 if (note->namesz == 6
9632 && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
9633 return elfcore_grok_prxfpreg (abfd, note);
9637 case NT_X86_XSTATE: /* Linux XSAVE extension */
9638 if (note->namesz == 6
9639 && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
9640 return elfcore_grok_xstatereg (abfd, note);
9645 if (note->namesz == 6
9646 && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
9647 return elfcore_grok_ppc_vmx (abfd, note);
9652 if (note->namesz == 6
9653 && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
9654 return elfcore_grok_ppc_vsx (abfd, note);
9658 case NT_S390_HIGH_GPRS:
9659 if (note->namesz == 6
9660 && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
9661 return elfcore_grok_s390_high_gprs (abfd, note);
9666 if (note->namesz == 6
9667 && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
9668 return elfcore_grok_s390_timer (abfd, note);
9672 case NT_S390_TODCMP:
9673 if (note->namesz == 6
9674 && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
9675 return elfcore_grok_s390_todcmp (abfd, note);
9679 case NT_S390_TODPREG:
9680 if (note->namesz == 6
9681 && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
9682 return elfcore_grok_s390_todpreg (abfd, note);
9687 if (note->namesz == 6
9688 && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
9689 return elfcore_grok_s390_ctrs (abfd, note);
9693 case NT_S390_PREFIX:
9694 if (note->namesz == 6
9695 && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
9696 return elfcore_grok_s390_prefix (abfd, note);
9700 case NT_S390_LAST_BREAK:
9701 if (note->namesz == 6
9702 && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
9703 return elfcore_grok_s390_last_break (abfd, note);
9707 case NT_S390_SYSTEM_CALL:
9708 if (note->namesz == 6
9709 && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
9710 return elfcore_grok_s390_system_call (abfd, note);
9715 if (note->namesz == 6
9716 && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
9717 return elfcore_grok_s390_tdb (abfd, note);
9721 case NT_S390_VXRS_LOW:
9722 if (note->namesz == 6
9723 && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
9724 return elfcore_grok_s390_vxrs_low (abfd, note);
9728 case NT_S390_VXRS_HIGH:
9729 if (note->namesz == 6
9730 && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
9731 return elfcore_grok_s390_vxrs_high (abfd, note);
9736 if (note->namesz == 6
9737 && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
9738 return elfcore_grok_s390_gs_cb (abfd, note);
9743 if (note->namesz == 6
9744 && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
9745 return elfcore_grok_s390_gs_bc (abfd, note);
9750 if (note->namesz == 6
9751 && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
9752 return elfcore_grok_arm_vfp (abfd, note);
9757 if (note->namesz == 6
9758 && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
9759 return elfcore_grok_aarch_tls (abfd, note);
9763 case NT_ARM_HW_BREAK:
9764 if (note->namesz == 6
9765 && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
9766 return elfcore_grok_aarch_hw_break (abfd, note);
9770 case NT_ARM_HW_WATCH:
9771 if (note->namesz == 6
9772 && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
9773 return elfcore_grok_aarch_hw_watch (abfd, note);
9779 if (bed->elf_backend_grok_psinfo)
9780 if ((*bed->elf_backend_grok_psinfo) (abfd, note))
9782 #if defined (HAVE_PRPSINFO_T) || defined (HAVE_PSINFO_T)
9783 return elfcore_grok_psinfo (abfd, note);
9790 asection *sect = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, ".auxv",
9795 sect->size = note->descsz;
9796 sect->filepos = note->descpos;
9797 sect->alignment_power = 1 + bfd_get_arch_size (abfd) / 32;
9803 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".note.linuxcore.file",
9807 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".note.linuxcore.siginfo",
9814 elfobj_grok_gnu_build_id (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9816 struct bfd_build_id* build_id;
9818 if (note->descsz == 0)
9821 build_id = bfd_alloc (abfd, sizeof (struct bfd_build_id) - 1 + note->descsz);
9822 if (build_id == NULL)
9825 build_id->size = note->descsz;
9826 memcpy (build_id->data, note->descdata, note->descsz);
9827 abfd->build_id = build_id;
9833 elfobj_grok_gnu_note (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9840 case NT_GNU_PROPERTY_TYPE_0:
9841 return _bfd_elf_parse_gnu_properties (abfd, note);
9843 case NT_GNU_BUILD_ID:
9844 return elfobj_grok_gnu_build_id (abfd, note);
9849 elfobj_grok_stapsdt_note_1 (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9851 struct sdt_note *cur =
9852 (struct sdt_note *) bfd_alloc (abfd, sizeof (struct sdt_note)
9855 cur->next = (struct sdt_note *) (elf_tdata (abfd))->sdt_note_head;
9856 cur->size = (bfd_size_type) note->descsz;
9857 memcpy (cur->data, note->descdata, note->descsz);
9859 elf_tdata (abfd)->sdt_note_head = cur;
9865 elfobj_grok_stapsdt_note (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9870 return elfobj_grok_stapsdt_note_1 (abfd, note);
9878 elfcore_grok_freebsd_psinfo (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9882 switch (elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_ident[EI_CLASS])
9885 if (note->descsz < 108)
9890 if (note->descsz < 120)
9898 /* Check for version 1 in pr_version. */
9899 if (bfd_h_get_32 (abfd, (bfd_byte *) note->descdata) != 1)
9904 /* Skip over pr_psinfosz. */
9905 if (elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_ident[EI_CLASS] == ELFCLASS32)
9909 offset += 4; /* Padding before pr_psinfosz. */
9913 /* pr_fname is PRFNAMESZ (16) + 1 bytes in size. */
9914 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->program
9915 = _bfd_elfcore_strndup (abfd, note->descdata + offset, 17);
9918 /* pr_psargs is PRARGSZ (80) + 1 bytes in size. */
9919 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->command
9920 = _bfd_elfcore_strndup (abfd, note->descdata + offset, 81);
9923 /* Padding before pr_pid. */
9926 /* The pr_pid field was added in version "1a". */
9927 if (note->descsz < offset + 4)
9930 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->pid
9931 = bfd_h_get_32 (abfd, (bfd_byte *) note->descdata + offset);
9937 elfcore_grok_freebsd_prstatus (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9943 /* Compute offset of pr_getregsz, skipping over pr_statussz.
9944 Also compute minimum size of this note. */
9945 switch (elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_ident[EI_CLASS])
9949 min_size = offset + (4 * 2) + 4 + 4 + 4;
9953 offset = 4 + 4 + 8; /* Includes padding before pr_statussz. */
9954 min_size = offset + (8 * 2) + 4 + 4 + 4 + 4;
9961 if (note->descsz < min_size)
9964 /* Check for version 1 in pr_version. */
9965 if (bfd_h_get_32 (abfd, (bfd_byte *) note->descdata) != 1)
9968 /* Extract size of pr_reg from pr_gregsetsz. */
9969 /* Skip over pr_gregsetsz and pr_fpregsetsz. */
9970 if (elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_ident[EI_CLASS] == ELFCLASS32)
9972 size = bfd_h_get_32 (abfd, (bfd_byte *) note->descdata + offset);
9977 size = bfd_h_get_64 (abfd, (bfd_byte *) note->descdata + offset);
9981 /* Skip over pr_osreldate. */
9984 /* Read signal from pr_cursig. */
9985 if (elf_tdata (abfd)->core->signal == 0)
9986 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->signal
9987 = bfd_h_get_32 (abfd, (bfd_byte *) note->descdata + offset);
9990 /* Read TID from pr_pid. */
9991 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->lwpid
9992 = bfd_h_get_32 (abfd, (bfd_byte *) note->descdata + offset);
9995 /* Padding before pr_reg. */
9996 if (elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_ident[EI_CLASS] == ELFCLASS64)
9999 /* Make sure that there is enough data remaining in the note. */
10000 if ((note->descsz - offset) < size)
10003 /* Make a ".reg/999" section and a ".reg" section. */
10004 return _bfd_elfcore_make_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg",
10005 size, note->descpos + offset);
10009 elfcore_grok_freebsd_note (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
10011 const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
10013 switch (note->type)
10016 if (bed->elf_backend_grok_freebsd_prstatus)
10017 if ((*bed->elf_backend_grok_freebsd_prstatus) (abfd, note))
10019 return elfcore_grok_freebsd_prstatus (abfd, note);
10022 return elfcore_grok_prfpreg (abfd, note);
10025 return elfcore_grok_freebsd_psinfo (abfd, note);
10027 case NT_FREEBSD_THRMISC:
10028 if (note->namesz == 8)
10029 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".thrmisc", note);
10033 case NT_FREEBSD_PROCSTAT_PROC:
10034 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".note.freebsdcore.proc",
10037 case NT_FREEBSD_PROCSTAT_FILES:
10038 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".note.freebsdcore.files",
10041 case NT_FREEBSD_PROCSTAT_VMMAP:
10042 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".note.freebsdcore.vmmap",
10045 case NT_FREEBSD_PROCSTAT_AUXV:
10047 asection *sect = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, ".auxv",
10052 sect->size = note->descsz - 4;
10053 sect->filepos = note->descpos + 4;
10054 sect->alignment_power = 1 + bfd_get_arch_size (abfd) / 32;
10059 case NT_X86_XSTATE:
10060 if (note->namesz == 8)
10061 return elfcore_grok_xstatereg (abfd, note);
10065 case NT_FREEBSD_PTLWPINFO:
10066 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".note.freebsdcore.lwpinfo",
10070 return elfcore_grok_arm_vfp (abfd, note);
10078 elfcore_netbsd_get_lwpid (Elf_Internal_Note *note, int *lwpidp)
10082 cp = strchr (note->namedata, '@');
10085 *lwpidp = atoi(cp + 1);
10092 elfcore_grok_netbsd_procinfo (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
10094 if (note->descsz <= 0x7c + 31)
10097 /* Signal number at offset 0x08. */
10098 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->signal
10099 = bfd_h_get_32 (abfd, (bfd_byte *) note->descdata + 0x08);
10101 /* Process ID at offset 0x50. */
10102 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->pid
10103 = bfd_h_get_32 (abfd, (bfd_byte *) note->descdata + 0x50);
10105 /* Command name at 0x7c (max 32 bytes, including nul). */
10106 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->command
10107 = _bfd_elfcore_strndup (abfd, note->descdata + 0x7c, 31);
10109 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".note.netbsdcore.procinfo",
10114 elfcore_grok_netbsd_note (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
10118 if (elfcore_netbsd_get_lwpid (note, &lwp))
10119 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->lwpid = lwp;
10121 if (note->type == NT_NETBSDCORE_PROCINFO)
10123 /* NetBSD-specific core "procinfo". Note that we expect to
10124 find this note before any of the others, which is fine,
10125 since the kernel writes this note out first when it
10126 creates a core file. */
10128 return elfcore_grok_netbsd_procinfo (abfd, note);
10131 /* As of Jan 2002 there are no other machine-independent notes
10132 defined for NetBSD core files. If the note type is less
10133 than the start of the machine-dependent note types, we don't
10136 if (note->type < NT_NETBSDCORE_FIRSTMACH)
10140 switch (bfd_get_arch (abfd))
10142 /* On the Alpha, SPARC (32-bit and 64-bit), PT_GETREGS == mach+0 and
10143 PT_GETFPREGS == mach+2. */
10145 case bfd_arch_alpha:
10146 case bfd_arch_sparc:
10147 switch (note->type)
10149 case NT_NETBSDCORE_FIRSTMACH+0:
10150 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg", note);
10152 case NT_NETBSDCORE_FIRSTMACH+2:
10153 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg2", note);
10159 /* On all other arch's, PT_GETREGS == mach+1 and
10160 PT_GETFPREGS == mach+3. */
10163 switch (note->type)
10165 case NT_NETBSDCORE_FIRSTMACH+1:
10166 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg", note);
10168 case NT_NETBSDCORE_FIRSTMACH+3:
10169 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg2", note);
10179 elfcore_grok_openbsd_procinfo (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
10181 if (note->descsz <= 0x48 + 31)
10184 /* Signal number at offset 0x08. */
10185 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->signal
10186 = bfd_h_get_32 (abfd, (bfd_byte *) note->descdata + 0x08);
10188 /* Process ID at offset 0x20. */
10189 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->pid
10190 = bfd_h_get_32 (abfd, (bfd_byte *) note->descdata + 0x20);
10192 /* Command name at 0x48 (max 32 bytes, including nul). */
10193 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->command
10194 = _bfd_elfcore_strndup (abfd, note->descdata + 0x48, 31);
10200 elfcore_grok_openbsd_note (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
10202 if (note->type == NT_OPENBSD_PROCINFO)
10203 return elfcore_grok_openbsd_procinfo (abfd, note);
10205 if (note->type == NT_OPENBSD_REGS)
10206 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg", note);
10208 if (note->type == NT_OPENBSD_FPREGS)
10209 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg2", note);
10211 if (note->type == NT_OPENBSD_XFPREGS)
10212 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-xfp", note);
10214 if (note->type == NT_OPENBSD_AUXV)
10216 asection *sect = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, ".auxv",
10221 sect->size = note->descsz;
10222 sect->filepos = note->descpos;
10223 sect->alignment_power = 1 + bfd_get_arch_size (abfd) / 32;
10228 if (note->type == NT_OPENBSD_WCOOKIE)
10230 asection *sect = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, ".wcookie",
10235 sect->size = note->descsz;
10236 sect->filepos = note->descpos;
10237 sect->alignment_power = 1 + bfd_get_arch_size (abfd) / 32;
10246 elfcore_grok_nto_status (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note, long *tid)
10248 void *ddata = note->descdata;
10255 if (note->descsz < 16)
10258 /* nto_procfs_status 'pid' field is at offset 0. */
10259 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->pid = bfd_get_32 (abfd, (bfd_byte *) ddata);
10261 /* nto_procfs_status 'tid' field is at offset 4. Pass it back. */
10262 *tid = bfd_get_32 (abfd, (bfd_byte *) ddata + 4);
10264 /* nto_procfs_status 'flags' field is at offset 8. */
10265 flags = bfd_get_32 (abfd, (bfd_byte *) ddata + 8);
10267 /* nto_procfs_status 'what' field is at offset 14. */
10268 if ((sig = bfd_get_16 (abfd, (bfd_byte *) ddata + 14)) > 0)
10270 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->signal = sig;
10271 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->lwpid = *tid;
10274 /* _DEBUG_FLAG_CURTID (current thread) is 0x80. Some cores
10275 do not come from signals so we make sure we set the current
10276 thread just in case. */
10277 if (flags & 0x00000080)
10278 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->lwpid = *tid;
10280 /* Make a ".qnx_core_status/%d" section. */
10281 sprintf (buf, ".qnx_core_status/%ld", *tid);
10283 name = (char *) bfd_alloc (abfd, strlen (buf) + 1);
10286 strcpy (name, buf);
10288 sect = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, name, SEC_HAS_CONTENTS);
10292 sect->size = note->descsz;
10293 sect->filepos = note->descpos;
10294 sect->alignment_power = 2;
10296 return (elfcore_maybe_make_sect (abfd, ".qnx_core_status", sect));
10300 elfcore_grok_nto_regs (bfd *abfd,
10301 Elf_Internal_Note *note,
10309 /* Make a "(base)/%d" section. */
10310 sprintf (buf, "%s/%ld", base, tid);
10312 name = (char *) bfd_alloc (abfd, strlen (buf) + 1);
10315 strcpy (name, buf);
10317 sect = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, name, SEC_HAS_CONTENTS);
10321 sect->size = note->descsz;
10322 sect->filepos = note->descpos;
10323 sect->alignment_power = 2;
10325 /* This is the current thread. */
10326 if (elf_tdata (abfd)->core->lwpid == tid)
10327 return elfcore_maybe_make_sect (abfd, base, sect);
10332 #define BFD_QNT_CORE_INFO 7
10333 #define BFD_QNT_CORE_STATUS 8
10334 #define BFD_QNT_CORE_GREG 9
10335 #define BFD_QNT_CORE_FPREG 10
10338 elfcore_grok_nto_note (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
10340 /* Every GREG section has a STATUS section before it. Store the
10341 tid from the previous call to pass down to the next gregs
10343 static long tid = 1;
10345 switch (note->type)
10347 case BFD_QNT_CORE_INFO:
10348 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".qnx_core_info", note);
10349 case BFD_QNT_CORE_STATUS:
10350 return elfcore_grok_nto_status (abfd, note, &tid);
10351 case BFD_QNT_CORE_GREG:
10352 return elfcore_grok_nto_regs (abfd, note, tid, ".reg");
10353 case BFD_QNT_CORE_FPREG:
10354 return elfcore_grok_nto_regs (abfd, note, tid, ".reg2");
10361 elfcore_grok_spu_note (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
10367 /* Use note name as section name. */
10368 len = note->namesz;
10369 name = (char *) bfd_alloc (abfd, len);
10372 memcpy (name, note->namedata, len);
10373 name[len - 1] = '\0';
10375 sect = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, name, SEC_HAS_CONTENTS);
10379 sect->size = note->descsz;
10380 sect->filepos = note->descpos;
10381 sect->alignment_power = 1;
10386 /* Function: elfcore_write_note
10389 buffer to hold note, and current size of buffer
10393 size of data for note
10395 Writes note to end of buffer. ELF64 notes are written exactly as
10396 for ELF32, despite the current (as of 2006) ELF gabi specifying
10397 that they ought to have 8-byte namesz and descsz field, and have
10398 8-byte alignment. Other writers, eg. Linux kernel, do the same.
10401 Pointer to realloc'd buffer, *BUFSIZ updated. */
10404 elfcore_write_note (bfd *abfd,
10412 Elf_External_Note *xnp;
10419 namesz = strlen (name) + 1;
10421 newspace = 12 + ((namesz + 3) & -4) + ((size + 3) & -4);
10423 buf = (char *) realloc (buf, *bufsiz + newspace);
10426 dest = buf + *bufsiz;
10427 *bufsiz += newspace;
10428 xnp = (Elf_External_Note *) dest;
10429 H_PUT_32 (abfd, namesz, xnp->namesz);
10430 H_PUT_32 (abfd, size, xnp->descsz);
10431 H_PUT_32 (abfd, type, xnp->type);
10435 memcpy (dest, name, namesz);
10443 memcpy (dest, input, size);
10454 elfcore_write_prpsinfo (bfd *abfd,
10458 const char *psargs)
10460 const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
10462 if (bed->elf_backend_write_core_note != NULL)
10465 ret = (*bed->elf_backend_write_core_note) (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
10466 NT_PRPSINFO, fname, psargs);
10471 #if defined (HAVE_PRPSINFO_T) || defined (HAVE_PSINFO_T)
10472 #if defined (HAVE_PRPSINFO32_T) || defined (HAVE_PSINFO32_T)
10473 if (bed->s->elfclass == ELFCLASS32)
10475 #if defined (HAVE_PSINFO32_T)
10477 int note_type = NT_PSINFO;
10480 int note_type = NT_PRPSINFO;
10483 memset (&data, 0, sizeof (data));
10484 strncpy (data.pr_fname, fname, sizeof (data.pr_fname));
10485 strncpy (data.pr_psargs, psargs, sizeof (data.pr_psargs));
10486 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
10487 "CORE", note_type, &data, sizeof (data));
10492 #if defined (HAVE_PSINFO_T)
10494 int note_type = NT_PSINFO;
10497 int note_type = NT_PRPSINFO;
10500 memset (&data, 0, sizeof (data));
10501 strncpy (data.pr_fname, fname, sizeof (data.pr_fname));
10502 strncpy (data.pr_psargs, psargs, sizeof (data.pr_psargs));
10503 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
10504 "CORE", note_type, &data, sizeof (data));
10506 #endif /* PSINFO_T or PRPSINFO_T */
10513 elfcore_write_linux_prpsinfo32
10514 (bfd *abfd, char *buf, int *bufsiz,
10515 const struct elf_internal_linux_prpsinfo *prpsinfo)
10517 if (get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->linux_prpsinfo32_ugid16)
10519 struct elf_external_linux_prpsinfo32_ugid16 data;
10521 swap_linux_prpsinfo32_ugid16_out (abfd, prpsinfo, &data);
10522 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz, "CORE", NT_PRPSINFO,
10523 &data, sizeof (data));
10527 struct elf_external_linux_prpsinfo32_ugid32 data;
10529 swap_linux_prpsinfo32_ugid32_out (abfd, prpsinfo, &data);
10530 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz, "CORE", NT_PRPSINFO,
10531 &data, sizeof (data));
10536 elfcore_write_linux_prpsinfo64
10537 (bfd *abfd, char *buf, int *bufsiz,
10538 const struct elf_internal_linux_prpsinfo *prpsinfo)
10540 if (get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->linux_prpsinfo64_ugid16)
10542 struct elf_external_linux_prpsinfo64_ugid16 data;
10544 swap_linux_prpsinfo64_ugid16_out (abfd, prpsinfo, &data);
10545 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
10546 "CORE", NT_PRPSINFO, &data, sizeof (data));
10550 struct elf_external_linux_prpsinfo64_ugid32 data;
10552 swap_linux_prpsinfo64_ugid32_out (abfd, prpsinfo, &data);
10553 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
10554 "CORE", NT_PRPSINFO, &data, sizeof (data));
10559 elfcore_write_prstatus (bfd *abfd,
10566 const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
10568 if (bed->elf_backend_write_core_note != NULL)
10571 ret = (*bed->elf_backend_write_core_note) (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
10573 pid, cursig, gregs);
10578 #if defined (HAVE_PRSTATUS_T)
10579 #if defined (HAVE_PRSTATUS32_T)
10580 if (bed->s->elfclass == ELFCLASS32)
10582 prstatus32_t prstat;
10584 memset (&prstat, 0, sizeof (prstat));
10585 prstat.pr_pid = pid;
10586 prstat.pr_cursig = cursig;
10587 memcpy (&prstat.pr_reg, gregs, sizeof (prstat.pr_reg));
10588 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz, "CORE",
10589 NT_PRSTATUS, &prstat, sizeof (prstat));
10596 memset (&prstat, 0, sizeof (prstat));
10597 prstat.pr_pid = pid;
10598 prstat.pr_cursig = cursig;
10599 memcpy (&prstat.pr_reg, gregs, sizeof (prstat.pr_reg));
10600 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz, "CORE",
10601 NT_PRSTATUS, &prstat, sizeof (prstat));
10603 #endif /* HAVE_PRSTATUS_T */
10609 #if defined (HAVE_LWPSTATUS_T)
10611 elfcore_write_lwpstatus (bfd *abfd,
10618 lwpstatus_t lwpstat;
10619 const char *note_name = "CORE";
10621 memset (&lwpstat, 0, sizeof (lwpstat));
10622 lwpstat.pr_lwpid = pid >> 16;
10623 lwpstat.pr_cursig = cursig;
10624 #if defined (HAVE_LWPSTATUS_T_PR_REG)
10625 memcpy (&lwpstat.pr_reg, gregs, sizeof (lwpstat.pr_reg));
10626 #elif defined (HAVE_LWPSTATUS_T_PR_CONTEXT)
10627 #if !defined(gregs)
10628 memcpy (lwpstat.pr_context.uc_mcontext.gregs,
10629 gregs, sizeof (lwpstat.pr_context.uc_mcontext.gregs));
10631 memcpy (lwpstat.pr_context.uc_mcontext.__gregs,
10632 gregs, sizeof (lwpstat.pr_context.uc_mcontext.__gregs));
10635 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz, note_name,
10636 NT_LWPSTATUS, &lwpstat, sizeof (lwpstat));
10638 #endif /* HAVE_LWPSTATUS_T */
10640 #if defined (HAVE_PSTATUS_T)
10642 elfcore_write_pstatus (bfd *abfd,
10646 int cursig ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
10647 const void *gregs ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
10649 const char *note_name = "CORE";
10650 #if defined (HAVE_PSTATUS32_T)
10651 const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
10653 if (bed->s->elfclass == ELFCLASS32)
10657 memset (&pstat, 0, sizeof (pstat));
10658 pstat.pr_pid = pid & 0xffff;
10659 buf = elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz, note_name,
10660 NT_PSTATUS, &pstat, sizeof (pstat));
10668 memset (&pstat, 0, sizeof (pstat));
10669 pstat.pr_pid = pid & 0xffff;
10670 buf = elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz, note_name,
10671 NT_PSTATUS, &pstat, sizeof (pstat));
10675 #endif /* HAVE_PSTATUS_T */
10678 elfcore_write_prfpreg (bfd *abfd,
10681 const void *fpregs,
10684 const char *note_name = "CORE";
10685 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
10686 note_name, NT_FPREGSET, fpregs, size);
10690 elfcore_write_prxfpreg (bfd *abfd,
10693 const void *xfpregs,
10696 char *note_name = "LINUX";
10697 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
10698 note_name, NT_PRXFPREG, xfpregs, size);
10702 elfcore_write_xstatereg (bfd *abfd, char *buf, int *bufsiz,
10703 const void *xfpregs, int size)
10706 if (get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->elf_osabi == ELFOSABI_FREEBSD)
10707 note_name = "FreeBSD";
10709 note_name = "LINUX";
10710 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
10711 note_name, NT_X86_XSTATE, xfpregs, size);
10715 elfcore_write_ppc_vmx (bfd *abfd,
10718 const void *ppc_vmx,
10721 char *note_name = "LINUX";
10722 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
10723 note_name, NT_PPC_VMX, ppc_vmx, size);
10727 elfcore_write_ppc_vsx (bfd *abfd,
10730 const void *ppc_vsx,
10733 char *note_name = "LINUX";
10734 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
10735 note_name, NT_PPC_VSX, ppc_vsx, size);
10739 elfcore_write_s390_high_gprs (bfd *abfd,
10742 const void *s390_high_gprs,
10745 char *note_name = "LINUX";
10746 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
10747 note_name, NT_S390_HIGH_GPRS,
10748 s390_high_gprs, size);
10752 elfcore_write_s390_timer (bfd *abfd,
10755 const void *s390_timer,
10758 char *note_name = "LINUX";
10759 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
10760 note_name, NT_S390_TIMER, s390_timer, size);
10764 elfcore_write_s390_todcmp (bfd *abfd,
10767 const void *s390_todcmp,
10770 char *note_name = "LINUX";
10771 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
10772 note_name, NT_S390_TODCMP, s390_todcmp, size);
10776 elfcore_write_s390_todpreg (bfd *abfd,
10779 const void *s390_todpreg,
10782 char *note_name = "LINUX";
10783 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
10784 note_name, NT_S390_TODPREG, s390_todpreg, size);
10788 elfcore_write_s390_ctrs (bfd *abfd,
10791 const void *s390_ctrs,
10794 char *note_name = "LINUX";
10795 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
10796 note_name, NT_S390_CTRS, s390_ctrs, size);
10800 elfcore_write_s390_prefix (bfd *abfd,
10803 const void *s390_prefix,
10806 char *note_name = "LINUX";
10807 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
10808 note_name, NT_S390_PREFIX, s390_prefix, size);
10812 elfcore_write_s390_last_break (bfd *abfd,
10815 const void *s390_last_break,
10818 char *note_name = "LINUX";
10819 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
10820 note_name, NT_S390_LAST_BREAK,
10821 s390_last_break, size);
10825 elfcore_write_s390_system_call (bfd *abfd,
10828 const void *s390_system_call,
10831 char *note_name = "LINUX";
10832 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
10833 note_name, NT_S390_SYSTEM_CALL,
10834 s390_system_call, size);
10838 elfcore_write_s390_tdb (bfd *abfd,
10841 const void *s390_tdb,
10844 char *note_name = "LINUX";
10845 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
10846 note_name, NT_S390_TDB, s390_tdb, size);
10850 elfcore_write_s390_vxrs_low (bfd *abfd,
10853 const void *s390_vxrs_low,
10856 char *note_name = "LINUX";
10857 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
10858 note_name, NT_S390_VXRS_LOW, s390_vxrs_low, size);
10862 elfcore_write_s390_vxrs_high (bfd *abfd,
10865 const void *s390_vxrs_high,
10868 char *note_name = "LINUX";
10869 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
10870 note_name, NT_S390_VXRS_HIGH,
10871 s390_vxrs_high, size);
10875 elfcore_write_s390_gs_cb (bfd *abfd,
10878 const void *s390_gs_cb,
10881 char *note_name = "LINUX";
10882 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
10883 note_name, NT_S390_GS_CB,
10888 elfcore_write_s390_gs_bc (bfd *abfd,
10891 const void *s390_gs_bc,
10894 char *note_name = "LINUX";
10895 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
10896 note_name, NT_S390_GS_BC,
10901 elfcore_write_arm_vfp (bfd *abfd,
10904 const void *arm_vfp,
10907 char *note_name = "LINUX";
10908 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
10909 note_name, NT_ARM_VFP, arm_vfp, size);
10913 elfcore_write_aarch_tls (bfd *abfd,
10916 const void *aarch_tls,
10919 char *note_name = "LINUX";
10920 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
10921 note_name, NT_ARM_TLS, aarch_tls, size);
10925 elfcore_write_aarch_hw_break (bfd *abfd,
10928 const void *aarch_hw_break,
10931 char *note_name = "LINUX";
10932 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
10933 note_name, NT_ARM_HW_BREAK, aarch_hw_break, size);
10937 elfcore_write_aarch_hw_watch (bfd *abfd,
10940 const void *aarch_hw_watch,
10943 char *note_name = "LINUX";
10944 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
10945 note_name, NT_ARM_HW_WATCH, aarch_hw_watch, size);
10949 elfcore_write_register_note (bfd *abfd,
10952 const char *section,
10956 if (strcmp (section, ".reg2") == 0)
10957 return elfcore_write_prfpreg (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
10958 if (strcmp (section, ".reg-xfp") == 0)
10959 return elfcore_write_prxfpreg (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
10960 if (strcmp (section, ".reg-xstate") == 0)
10961 return elfcore_write_xstatereg (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
10962 if (strcmp (section, ".reg-ppc-vmx") == 0)
10963 return elfcore_write_ppc_vmx (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
10964 if (strcmp (section, ".reg-ppc-vsx") == 0)
10965 return elfcore_write_ppc_vsx (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
10966 if (strcmp (section, ".reg-s390-high-gprs") == 0)
10967 return elfcore_write_s390_high_gprs (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
10968 if (strcmp (section, ".reg-s390-timer") == 0)
10969 return elfcore_write_s390_timer (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
10970 if (strcmp (section, ".reg-s390-todcmp") == 0)
10971 return elfcore_write_s390_todcmp (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
10972 if (strcmp (section, ".reg-s390-todpreg") == 0)
10973 return elfcore_write_s390_todpreg (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
10974 if (strcmp (section, ".reg-s390-ctrs") == 0)
10975 return elfcore_write_s390_ctrs (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
10976 if (strcmp (section, ".reg-s390-prefix") == 0)
10977 return elfcore_write_s390_prefix (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
10978 if (strcmp (section, ".reg-s390-last-break") == 0)
10979 return elfcore_write_s390_last_break (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
10980 if (strcmp (section, ".reg-s390-system-call") == 0)
10981 return elfcore_write_s390_system_call (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
10982 if (strcmp (section, ".reg-s390-tdb") == 0)
10983 return elfcore_write_s390_tdb (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
10984 if (strcmp (section, ".reg-s390-vxrs-low") == 0)
10985 return elfcore_write_s390_vxrs_low (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
10986 if (strcmp (section, ".reg-s390-vxrs-high") == 0)
10987 return elfcore_write_s390_vxrs_high (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
10988 if (strcmp (section, ".reg-s390-gs-cb") == 0)
10989 return elfcore_write_s390_gs_cb (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
10990 if (strcmp (section, ".reg-s390-gs-bc") == 0)
10991 return elfcore_write_s390_gs_bc (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
10992 if (strcmp (section, ".reg-arm-vfp") == 0)
10993 return elfcore_write_arm_vfp (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
10994 if (strcmp (section, ".reg-aarch-tls") == 0)
10995 return elfcore_write_aarch_tls (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
10996 if (strcmp (section, ".reg-aarch-hw-break") == 0)
10997 return elfcore_write_aarch_hw_break (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
10998 if (strcmp (section, ".reg-aarch-hw-watch") == 0)
10999 return elfcore_write_aarch_hw_watch (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
11004 elf_parse_notes (bfd *abfd, char *buf, size_t size, file_ptr offset,
11009 /* NB: CORE PT_NOTE segments may have p_align values of 0 or 1.
11010 gABI specifies that PT_NOTE alignment should be aligned to 4
11011 bytes for 32-bit objects and to 8 bytes for 64-bit objects. If
11012 align is less than 4, we use 4 byte alignment. */
11017 while (p < buf + size)
11019 Elf_External_Note *xnp = (Elf_External_Note *) p;
11020 Elf_Internal_Note in;
11022 if (offsetof (Elf_External_Note, name) > buf - p + size)
11025 in.type = H_GET_32 (abfd, xnp->type);
11027 in.namesz = H_GET_32 (abfd, xnp->namesz);
11028 in.namedata = xnp->name;
11029 if (in.namesz > buf - in.namedata + size)
11032 in.descsz = H_GET_32 (abfd, xnp->descsz);
11033 in.descdata = p + ELF_NOTE_DESC_OFFSET (in.namesz, align);
11034 in.descpos = offset + (in.descdata - buf);
11036 && (in.descdata >= buf + size
11037 || in.descsz > buf - in.descdata + size))
11040 switch (bfd_get_format (abfd))
11047 #define GROKER_ELEMENT(S,F) {S, sizeof (S) - 1, F}
11050 const char * string;
11052 bfd_boolean (* func)(bfd *, Elf_Internal_Note *);
11056 GROKER_ELEMENT ("", elfcore_grok_note),
11057 GROKER_ELEMENT ("FreeBSD", elfcore_grok_freebsd_note),
11058 GROKER_ELEMENT ("NetBSD-CORE", elfcore_grok_netbsd_note),
11059 GROKER_ELEMENT ( "OpenBSD", elfcore_grok_openbsd_note),
11060 GROKER_ELEMENT ("QNX", elfcore_grok_nto_note),
11061 GROKER_ELEMENT ("SPU/", elfcore_grok_spu_note)
11063 #undef GROKER_ELEMENT
11066 for (i = ARRAY_SIZE (grokers); i--;)
11068 if (in.namesz >= grokers[i].len
11069 && strncmp (in.namedata, grokers[i].string,
11070 grokers[i].len) == 0)
11072 if (! grokers[i].func (abfd, & in))
11081 if (in.namesz == sizeof "GNU" && strcmp (in.namedata, "GNU") == 0)
11083 if (! elfobj_grok_gnu_note (abfd, &in))
11086 else if (in.namesz == sizeof "stapsdt"
11087 && strcmp (in.namedata, "stapsdt") == 0)
11089 if (! elfobj_grok_stapsdt_note (abfd, &in))
11095 p += ELF_NOTE_NEXT_OFFSET (in.namesz, in.descsz, align);
11102 elf_read_notes (bfd *abfd, file_ptr offset, bfd_size_type size,
11107 if (size == 0 || (size + 1) == 0)
11110 if (bfd_seek (abfd, offset, SEEK_SET) != 0)
11113 buf = (char *) bfd_malloc (size + 1);
11117 /* PR 17512: file: ec08f814
11118 0-termintate the buffer so that string searches will not overflow. */
11121 if (bfd_bread (buf, size, abfd) != size
11122 || !elf_parse_notes (abfd, buf, size, offset, align))
11132 /* Providing external access to the ELF program header table. */
11134 /* Return an upper bound on the number of bytes required to store a
11135 copy of ABFD's program header table entries. Return -1 if an error
11136 occurs; bfd_get_error will return an appropriate code. */
11139 bfd_get_elf_phdr_upper_bound (bfd *abfd)
11141 if (abfd->xvec->flavour != bfd_target_elf_flavour)
11143 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_wrong_format);
11147 return elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_phnum * sizeof (Elf_Internal_Phdr);
11150 /* Copy ABFD's program header table entries to *PHDRS. The entries
11151 will be stored as an array of Elf_Internal_Phdr structures, as
11152 defined in include/elf/internal.h. To find out how large the
11153 buffer needs to be, call bfd_get_elf_phdr_upper_bound.
11155 Return the number of program header table entries read, or -1 if an
11156 error occurs; bfd_get_error will return an appropriate code. */
11159 bfd_get_elf_phdrs (bfd *abfd, void *phdrs)
11163 if (abfd->xvec->flavour != bfd_target_elf_flavour)
11165 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_wrong_format);
11169 num_phdrs = elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_phnum;
11170 memcpy (phdrs, elf_tdata (abfd)->phdr,
11171 num_phdrs * sizeof (Elf_Internal_Phdr));
11176 enum elf_reloc_type_class
11177 _bfd_elf_reloc_type_class (const struct bfd_link_info *info ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
11178 const asection *rel_sec ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
11179 const Elf_Internal_Rela *rela ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
11181 return reloc_class_normal;
11184 /* For RELA architectures, return the relocation value for a
11185 relocation against a local symbol. */
11188 _bfd_elf_rela_local_sym (bfd *abfd,
11189 Elf_Internal_Sym *sym,
11191 Elf_Internal_Rela *rel)
11193 asection *sec = *psec;
11194 bfd_vma relocation;
11196 relocation = (sec->output_section->vma
11197 + sec->output_offset
11199 if ((sec->flags & SEC_MERGE)
11200 && ELF_ST_TYPE (sym->st_info) == STT_SECTION
11201 && sec->sec_info_type == SEC_INFO_TYPE_MERGE)
11204 _bfd_merged_section_offset (abfd, psec,
11205 elf_section_data (sec)->sec_info,
11206 sym->st_value + rel->r_addend);
11209 /* If we have changed the section, and our original section is
11210 marked with SEC_EXCLUDE, it means that the original
11211 SEC_MERGE section has been completely subsumed in some
11212 other SEC_MERGE section. In this case, we need to leave
11213 some info around for --emit-relocs. */
11214 if ((sec->flags & SEC_EXCLUDE) != 0)
11215 sec->kept_section = *psec;
11218 rel->r_addend -= relocation;
11219 rel->r_addend += sec->output_section->vma + sec->output_offset;
11225 _bfd_elf_rel_local_sym (bfd *abfd,
11226 Elf_Internal_Sym *sym,
11230 asection *sec = *psec;
11232 if (sec->sec_info_type != SEC_INFO_TYPE_MERGE)
11233 return sym->st_value + addend;
11235 return _bfd_merged_section_offset (abfd, psec,
11236 elf_section_data (sec)->sec_info,
11237 sym->st_value + addend);
11240 /* Adjust an address within a section. Given OFFSET within SEC, return
11241 the new offset within the section, based upon changes made to the
11242 section. Returns -1 if the offset is now invalid.
11243 The offset (in abnd out) is in target sized bytes, however big a
11247 _bfd_elf_section_offset (bfd *abfd,
11248 struct bfd_link_info *info,
11252 switch (sec->sec_info_type)
11254 case SEC_INFO_TYPE_STABS:
11255 return _bfd_stab_section_offset (sec, elf_section_data (sec)->sec_info,
11257 case SEC_INFO_TYPE_EH_FRAME:
11258 return _bfd_elf_eh_frame_section_offset (abfd, info, sec, offset);
11261 if ((sec->flags & SEC_ELF_REVERSE_COPY) != 0)
11263 /* Reverse the offset. */
11264 const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
11265 bfd_size_type address_size = bed->s->arch_size / 8;
11267 /* address_size and sec->size are in octets. Convert
11268 to bytes before subtracting the original offset. */
11269 offset = (sec->size - address_size) / bfd_octets_per_byte (abfd) - offset;
11275 /* Create a new BFD as if by bfd_openr. Rather than opening a file,
11276 reconstruct an ELF file by reading the segments out of remote memory
11277 based on the ELF file header at EHDR_VMA and the ELF program headers it
11278 points to. If not null, *LOADBASEP is filled in with the difference
11279 between the VMAs from which the segments were read, and the VMAs the
11280 file headers (and hence BFD's idea of each section's VMA) put them at.
11282 The function TARGET_READ_MEMORY is called to copy LEN bytes from the
11283 remote memory at target address VMA into the local buffer at MYADDR; it
11284 should return zero on success or an `errno' code on failure. TEMPL must
11285 be a BFD for an ELF target with the word size and byte order found in
11286 the remote memory. */
11289 bfd_elf_bfd_from_remote_memory
11292 bfd_size_type size,
11293 bfd_vma *loadbasep,
11294 int (*target_read_memory) (bfd_vma, bfd_byte *, bfd_size_type))
11296 return (*get_elf_backend_data (templ)->elf_backend_bfd_from_remote_memory)
11297 (templ, ehdr_vma, size, loadbasep, target_read_memory);
11301 _bfd_elf_get_synthetic_symtab (bfd *abfd,
11302 long symcount ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
11303 asymbol **syms ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
11308 const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
11311 const char *relplt_name;
11312 bfd_boolean (*slurp_relocs) (bfd *, asection *, asymbol **, bfd_boolean);
11316 Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr;
11322 if ((abfd->flags & (DYNAMIC | EXEC_P)) == 0)
11325 if (dynsymcount <= 0)
11328 if (!bed->plt_sym_val)
11331 relplt_name = bed->relplt_name;
11332 if (relplt_name == NULL)
11333 relplt_name = bed->rela_plts_and_copies_p ? ".rela.plt" : ".rel.plt";
11334 relplt = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, relplt_name);
11335 if (relplt == NULL)
11338 hdr = &elf_section_data (relplt)->this_hdr;
11339 if (hdr->sh_link != elf_dynsymtab (abfd)
11340 || (hdr->sh_type != SHT_REL && hdr->sh_type != SHT_RELA))
11343 plt = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".plt");
11347 slurp_relocs = get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->s->slurp_reloc_table;
11348 if (! (*slurp_relocs) (abfd, relplt, dynsyms, TRUE))
11351 count = relplt->size / hdr->sh_entsize;
11352 size = count * sizeof (asymbol);
11353 p = relplt->relocation;
11354 for (i = 0; i < count; i++, p += bed->s->int_rels_per_ext_rel)
11356 size += strlen ((*p->sym_ptr_ptr)->name) + sizeof ("@plt");
11357 if (p->addend != 0)
11360 size += sizeof ("+0x") - 1 + 8 + 8 * (bed->s->elfclass == ELFCLASS64);
11362 size += sizeof ("+0x") - 1 + 8;
11367 s = *ret = (asymbol *) bfd_malloc (size);
11371 names = (char *) (s + count);
11372 p = relplt->relocation;
11374 for (i = 0; i < count; i++, p += bed->s->int_rels_per_ext_rel)
11379 addr = bed->plt_sym_val (i, plt, p);
11380 if (addr == (bfd_vma) -1)
11383 *s = **p->sym_ptr_ptr;
11384 /* Undefined syms won't have BSF_LOCAL or BSF_GLOBAL set. Since
11385 we are defining a symbol, ensure one of them is set. */
11386 if ((s->flags & BSF_LOCAL) == 0)
11387 s->flags |= BSF_GLOBAL;
11388 s->flags |= BSF_SYNTHETIC;
11390 s->value = addr - plt->vma;
11393 len = strlen ((*p->sym_ptr_ptr)->name);
11394 memcpy (names, (*p->sym_ptr_ptr)->name, len);
11396 if (p->addend != 0)
11400 memcpy (names, "+0x", sizeof ("+0x") - 1);
11401 names += sizeof ("+0x") - 1;
11402 bfd_sprintf_vma (abfd, buf, p->addend);
11403 for (a = buf; *a == '0'; ++a)
11406 memcpy (names, a, len);
11409 memcpy (names, "@plt", sizeof ("@plt"));
11410 names += sizeof ("@plt");
11417 /* It is only used by x86-64 so far.
11418 ??? This repeats *COM* id of zero. sec->id is supposed to be unique,
11419 but current usage would allow all of _bfd_std_section to be zero. */
11420 static const asymbol lcomm_sym
11421 = GLOBAL_SYM_INIT ("LARGE_COMMON", &_bfd_elf_large_com_section);
11422 asection _bfd_elf_large_com_section
11423 = BFD_FAKE_SECTION (_bfd_elf_large_com_section, &lcomm_sym,
11424 "LARGE_COMMON", 0, SEC_IS_COMMON);
11427 _bfd_elf_post_process_headers (bfd * abfd,
11428 struct bfd_link_info * link_info ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
11430 Elf_Internal_Ehdr * i_ehdrp; /* ELF file header, internal form. */
11432 i_ehdrp = elf_elfheader (abfd);
11434 i_ehdrp->e_ident[EI_OSABI] = get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->elf_osabi;
11436 /* To make things simpler for the loader on Linux systems we set the
11437 osabi field to ELFOSABI_GNU if the binary contains symbols of
11438 the STT_GNU_IFUNC type or STB_GNU_UNIQUE binding. */
11439 if (i_ehdrp->e_ident[EI_OSABI] == ELFOSABI_NONE
11440 && elf_tdata (abfd)->has_gnu_symbols)
11441 i_ehdrp->e_ident[EI_OSABI] = ELFOSABI_GNU;
11445 /* Return TRUE for ELF symbol types that represent functions.
11446 This is the default version of this function, which is sufficient for
11447 most targets. It returns true if TYPE is STT_FUNC or STT_GNU_IFUNC. */
11450 _bfd_elf_is_function_type (unsigned int type)
11452 return (type == STT_FUNC
11453 || type == STT_GNU_IFUNC);
11456 /* If the ELF symbol SYM might be a function in SEC, return the
11457 function size and set *CODE_OFF to the function's entry point,
11458 otherwise return zero. */
11461 _bfd_elf_maybe_function_sym (const asymbol *sym, asection *sec,
11464 bfd_size_type size;
11466 if ((sym->flags & (BSF_SECTION_SYM | BSF_FILE | BSF_OBJECT
11467 | BSF_THREAD_LOCAL | BSF_RELC | BSF_SRELC)) != 0
11468 || sym->section != sec)
11471 *code_off = sym->value;
11473 if (!(sym->flags & BSF_SYNTHETIC))
11474 size = ((elf_symbol_type *) sym)->internal_elf_sym.st_size;